nLab Introduction to Homotopy Theory

Redirected from "Introduction to Stable homotopy theory -- P".
Contents

These are lecture notes giving a detailed introduction to classical homotopy theory, starting with the concept of homotopy in topological spaces and motivating from this the “abstract homotopy theory” in general model categories.

\,

For background on basic topology see at Introduction to Topology.

For application to homological algebra see at Introduction to Homological Algebra.

For application to stable homotopy theory see at Introduction to Stable homotopy theory.


Context

Homotopy theory

homotopy theory, (∞,1)-category theory, homotopy type theory

flavors: stable, equivariant, rational, p-adic, proper, geometric, cohesive, directed

models: topological, simplicial, localic, …

see also algebraic topology

Introductions

Definitions

Paths and cylinders

Homotopy groups

Basic facts

Theorems

Contents

\,

While the field of algebraic topology clearly originates in topology, it is not actually interested in topological spaces regarded up to topological isomorphism, namely homeomorphism (“point-set topology”), but only in topological spaces regarded up to weak homotopy equivalence – hence it is interested only in the “weak homotopy types” of topological spaces. This is so notably because ordinary cohomology groups are invariants of the (weak) homotopy type of topological spaces but do not detect their homeomorphism class.

The category of topological spaces obtained by forcing weak homotopy equivalences to become isomorphisms is the “classical homotopy categoryHo(Top). This homotopy category however has forgotten a little too much information: homotopy theory really wants the weak homotopy equivalences not to become plain isomorphisms, but to become actual homotopy equivalences. The structure that reflects this is called a model category structure (short for “category of models for homotopy types”). For classical homotopy theory this is accordingly called the classical model structure on topological spaces. This we review here.

Topological homotopy theory

This section recalls relevant concepts from actual topology (“point-set topology”) and highlights facts that motivate the axiomatics of model categories below. We prove two technical lemmas (lemma and lemma ) that serve to establish the abstract homotopy theory of topological spaces further below.

Literature (Hirschhorn 15)

\,

Throughout, let Top denote the category whose objects are topological spaces and whose morphisms are continuous functions between them. Its isomorphisms are the homeomorphisms.

(Further below we restrict attention to the full subcategory of compactly generated topological spaces.)

Universal constructions

To begin with, we recall some basics on universal constructions in Top: limits and colimits of diagrams of topological spaces; exponential objects.

Generally, recall:

Definition

A diagram in a category 𝒞\mathcal{C} is a small category II and a functor

X :I𝒞 X_\bullet \;\colon\; I \longrightarrow \mathcal{C}
(iϕj)(X iX(ϕ)X j). (i \overset{\phi}{\longrightarrow} j) \; \mapsto ( X_i \overset{X(\phi)}{\longrightarrow} X_j) \,.

A cone over this diagram is an object QQ equipped with morphisms p i:QX ip_i \colon Q \longrightarrow X_i for all iIi \in I, such that all these triangles commute:

Q p i p j X i X(ϕ) X j. \array{ && Q \\ & {}^{\mathllap{p_i}}\swarrow && \searrow^{\mathrlap{p_j}} \\ X_i && \underset{X(\phi)}{\longrightarrow} && X_j } \,.

Dually, a co-cone under the diagram is QQ equipped with morphisms q i:X iQq_i \colon X_i \longrightarrow Q such that all these triangles commute:

X i X(ϕ) X j q i q j Q. \array{ X_i && \overset{X(\phi)}{\longrightarrow} && X_j \\ & {}_{\mathllap{q_i}}\searrow && \swarrow_{\mathrlap{q_j}} \\ && Q } \,.

A limit over the diagram is a universal cone, denoted lim iIX i\underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} X_i, that is: a cone such that every other cone uniquely factors through it Qlim iIX iQ \longrightarrow \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} X_i, making all the resulting triangles commute.

Dually, a colimit over the diagram is a universal co-cone, denoted lim iIX i\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} X_i.

We now discuss limits and colimits in 𝒞=\mathcal{C}= Top. The key for understanding these is the fact that there are initial and final topologies:

Definition

Let {X i=(S i,τ i)Top} iI\{X_i = (S_i,\tau_i) \in Top\}_{i \in I} be a set of topological spaces, and let SSetS \in Set be a bare set. Then

  1. For {Sf iS i} iI\{S \stackrel{f_i}{\to} S_i \}_{i \in I} a set of functions out of SS, the initial topology τ initial({f i} iI)\tau_{initial}(\{f_i\}_{i \in I}) is the topology on SS with the minimum collection of open subsets such that all f i:(S,τ initial({f i} iI))X if_i \colon (S,\tau_{initial}(\{f_i\}_{i \in I}))\to X_i are continuous.

  2. For {S if iS} iI\{S_i \stackrel{f_i}{\to} S\}_{i \in I} a set of functions into SS, the final topology τ final({f i} iI)\tau_{final}(\{f_i\}_{i \in I}) is the topology on SS with the maximum collection of open subsets such that all f i:X i(S,τ final({f i} iI))f_i \colon X_i \to (S,\tau_{final}(\{f_i\}_{i \in I})) are continuous.

Example

For XX a single topological space, and ι S:SU(X)\iota_S \colon S \hookrightarrow U(X) a subset of its underlying set, the initial topology τ initial(ι S)\tau_{initial}(\iota_S), def. , is the subspace topology, making

ι S:(S,τ initial(ι S))X \iota_S \;\colon\; (S, \tau_{initial}(\iota_S)) \hookrightarrow X

a topological subspace inclusion.

Example

Conversely, for p S:U(X)Sp_S \colon U(X) \longrightarrow S an epimorphism, the final topology τ final(p S)\tau_{final}(p_S) on SS is the quotient topology.

Proposition

Let II be a small category and let X :ITopX_\bullet \colon I \longrightarrow Top be an II-diagram in Top (a functor from II to TopTop), with components denoted X i=(S i,τ i)X_i = (S_i, \tau_i), where S iSetS_i \in Set and τ i\tau_i a topology on S iS_i. Then:

  1. The limit of X X_\bullet exists and is given by the topological space whose underlying set is the limit in Set of the underlying sets in the diagram, and whose topology is the initial topology, def. , for the functions p ip_i which are the limiting cone components:

    lim iIS i p i p j S i S j. \array{ && \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} S_i \\ & {}^{\mathllap{p_i}}\swarrow && \searrow^{\mathrlap{p_j}} \\ S_i && \underset{}{\longrightarrow} && S_j } \,.

    Hence

    lim iIX i(lim iIS i,τ initial({p i} iI)) \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} X_i \simeq \left(\underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} S_i,\; \tau_{initial}(\{p_i\}_{i \in I})\right)
  2. The colimit of X X_\bullet exists and is the topological space whose underlying set is the colimit in Set of the underlying diagram of sets, and whose topology is the final topology, def. for the component maps ι i\iota_i of the colimiting cocone

    S i S j ι i ι j lim iIS i. \array{ S_i && \longrightarrow && S_j \\ & {}_{\mathllap{\iota_i}}\searrow && \swarrow_{\mathrlap{\iota_j}} \\ && \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} S_i } \,.

    Hence

    lim iIX i(lim iIS i,τ final({ι i} iI)) \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} X_i \simeq \left(\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} S_i,\; \tau_{final}(\{\iota_i\}_{i \in I})\right)

(e.g. Bourbaki 71, section I.4)

Proof

The required universal property of (lim iIS i,τ initial({p i} iI))\left(\underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} S_i,\; \tau_{initial}(\{p_i\}_{i \in I})\right) (def. ) is immediate: for

(S,τ) f i f j X i X j \array{ && (S,\tau) \\ & {}^{\mathllap{f_i}}\swarrow && \searrow^{\mathrlap{f_j}} \\ X_i && \underset{}{\longrightarrow} && X_j }

any cone over the diagram, then by construction there is a unique function of underlying sets Slim iIS iS \longrightarrow \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_{i \in I} S_i making the required diagrams commute, and so all that is required is that this unique function is always continuous. But this is precisely what the initial topology ensures.

The case of the colimit is formally dual.

Example

The limit over the empty diagram in TopTop is the point *\ast with its unique topology.

Example

For {X i} iI\{X_i\}_{i \in I} a set of topological spaces, their coproduct iIX iTop\underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} X_i \in Top is their disjoint union.

In particular:

Example

For SSetS \in Set, the SS-indexed coproduct of the point, sS*\underset{s \in S}{\coprod}\ast is the set SS itself equipped with the final topology, hence is the discrete topological space on SS.

Example

For {X i} iI\{X_i\}_{i \in I} a set of topological spaces, their product iIX iTop\underset{i \in I}{\prod} X_i \in Top is the Cartesian product of the underlying sets equipped with the product topology, also called the Tychonoff product.

In the case that SS is a finite set, such as for binary product spaces X×YX \times Y, then a sub-basis for the product topology is given by the Cartesian products of the open subsets of (a basis for) each factor space.

Example

The equalizer of two continuous functions f,g:XYf, g \colon X \stackrel{\longrightarrow}{\longrightarrow} Y in TopTop is the equalizer of the underlying functions of sets

eq(f,g)S XgfS Y eq(f,g) \hookrightarrow S_X \stackrel{\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}}{\underset{g}{\longrightarrow}} S_Y

(hence the largest subset of S XS_X on which both functions coincide) and equipped with the subspace topology, example .

Example

The coequalizer of two continuous functions f,g:XYf, g \colon X \stackrel{\longrightarrow}{\longrightarrow} Y in TopTop is the coequalizer of the underlying functions of sets

S XgfS Ycoeq(f,g) S_X \stackrel{\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}}{\underset{g}{\longrightarrow}} S_Y \longrightarrow coeq(f,g)

(hence the quotient set by the equivalence relation generated by f(x)g(x)f(x) \sim g(x) for all xXx \in X) and equipped with the quotient topology, example .

Example

For

A g Y f X \array{ A &\overset{g}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow \\ X }

two continuous functions out of the same domain, the colimit under this diagram is also called the pushout, denoted

A g Y f g *f X X AY.. \array{ A &\overset{g}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{g_\ast f}} \\ X &\longrightarrow& X \sqcup_A Y \,. } \,.

(Here g *fg_\ast f is also called the pushout of ff, or the cobase change of ff along gg.)

This is equivalently the coequalizer of the two morphisms from AA to the coproduct of XX with YY (example ):

AXYX AY. A \stackrel{\longrightarrow}{\longrightarrow} X \sqcup Y \longrightarrow X \sqcup_A Y \,.

If gg is an inclusion, one also writes X fYX \cup_f Y and calls this the attaching space.

By example the pushout/attaching space is the quotient topological space

X AY(XY)/ X \sqcup_A Y \simeq (X\sqcup Y)/\sim

of the disjoint union of XX and YY subject to the equivalence relation which identifies a point in XX with a point in YY if they have the same pre-image in AA.

(graphics from Aguilar-Gitler-Prieto 02)

Notice that the defining universal property of this colimit means that completing the span

A Y X \array{ A &\longrightarrow& Y \\ \downarrow \\ X }

to a commuting square

A Y X Z \array{ A &\longrightarrow& Y \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ X &\longrightarrow& Z }

is equivalent to finding a morphism

XAYZ. X \underset{A}{\sqcup} Y \longrightarrow Z \,.
Example

For AXA\hookrightarrow X a topological subspace inclusion, example , the pushout

A X (po) * X/A \array{ A &\hookrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow &(po)& \downarrow \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& X/A }

is the quotient space or cofiber, denoted X/AX/A.

Example

An important special case of example :

For nn \in \mathbb{N} write

  • D n{x n||x|1} nD^n \coloneqq \{ \vec x\in \mathbb{R}^n | \; {\vert \vec x \vert \leq 1}\} \hookrightarrow \mathbb{R}^n for the standard topological n-disk (equipped with its subspace topology as a subset of Cartesian space);

  • S n1=D n{x n||x|=1} nS^{n-1} = \partial D^n \coloneqq \{ \vec x\in \mathbb{R}^n | \; {\vert \vec x \vert = 1}\} \hookrightarrow \mathbb{R}^n for its boundary, the standard topological n-sphere.

Notice that S 1=S^{-1} = \emptyset and that S 0=**S^0 = \ast \sqcup \ast.

Let

i n:S n1D n i_n \colon S^{n-1}\longrightarrow D^n

be the canonical inclusion of the standard (n-1)-sphere as the boundary of the standard n-disk (both regarded as topological spaces with their subspace topology as subspaces of the Cartesian space n\mathbb{R}^n).

Then the colimit in Top under the diagram

D ni nS n1i nD n, D^n \overset{i_n}{\longleftarrow} S^{n-1} \overset{i_n}{\longrightarrow} D^n \,,

i.e. the pushout of i ni_n along itself, is the n-sphere S nS^n:

S n1 i n D n i n (po) D n S n. \array{ S^{n-1} &\overset{i_n}{\longrightarrow}& D^n \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_n}}\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow \\ D^n &\longrightarrow& S^n } \,.

(graphics from Ueno-Shiga-Morita 95)

Another kind of colimit that will play a role for certain technical constructions is transfinite composition. First recall

Definition

A partial order is a set SS equipped with a relation \leq such that for all elements a,b,cSa,b,c \in S

1) (reflexivity) aaa \leq a;

2) (transitivity) if aba \leq b and bcb \leq c then aca \leq c;

3) (antisymmetry) if aba\leq b and ba\b \leq a then a=ba = b.

This we may and will equivalently think of as a category with objects the elements of SS and a unique morphism aba \to b precisely if aba\leq b. In particular an order-preserving function between partially ordered sets is equivalently a functor between their corresponding categories.

A bottom element \bot in a partial order is one such that a\bot \leq a for all a. A top element \top is one for which aa \leq \top.

A partial order is a total order if in addition

4) (totality) either aba\leq b or bab \leq a.

A total order is a well order if in addition

5) (well-foundedness) every non-empty subset has a least element.

An ordinal is the equivalence class of a well-order.

The successor of an ordinal is the class of the well-order with a top element freely adjoined.

A limit ordinal is one that is not a successor.

Example

The finite ordinals are labeled by nn \in \mathbb{N}, corresponding to the well-orders {012n1}\{0 \leq 1 \leq 2 \cdots \leq n-1\}. Here (n+1)(n+1) is the successor of nn. The first non-empty limit ordinal is ω=[(,)]\omega = [(\mathbb{N}, \leq)].

Definition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a category, and let IMor(𝒞)I \subset Mor(\mathcal{C}) be a class of its morphisms.

For α\alpha an ordinal (regarded as a category), an α\alpha-indexed transfinite sequence of elements in II is a diagram

X :α𝒞 X_\bullet \;\colon\; \alpha \longrightarrow \mathcal{C}

such that

  1. X X_\bullet takes all successor morphisms ββ+1\beta \stackrel{\leq}{\to} \beta + 1 in α\alpha to elements in II

    X β,β+1I X_{\beta,\beta + 1} \in I
  2. X X_\bullet is continuous in that for every nonzero limit ordinal β<α\beta \lt \alpha, X X_\bullet restricted to the full-subdiagram {γ|γβ}\{\gamma \;|\; \gamma \leq \beta\} is a colimiting cocone in 𝒞\mathcal{C} for X X_\bullet restricted to {γ|γ<β}\{\gamma \;|\; \gamma \lt \beta\}.

The corresponding transfinite composition is the induced morphism

X 0X αlimX X_0 \longrightarrow X_\alpha \coloneqq \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}X_\bullet

into the colimit of the diagram, schematically:

X 0 X 0,1 X 1 X 1,2 X 2 X α. \array{ X_0 &\stackrel{X_{0,1}}{\to}& X_1 &\stackrel{X_{1,2}}{\to}& X_2 &\to& \cdots \\ & \searrow & \downarrow & \swarrow & \cdots \\ && X_\alpha } \,.

We now turn to the discussion of mapping spaces/exponential objects.

Definition

For XX a topological space and YY a locally compact topological space (in that for every point, every neighbourhood contains a compact neighbourhood), the mapping space

X YTop X^Y \in Top

is the topological space

Accordingly this is called the compact-open topology on the set of functions.

The construction extends to a functor

() ():Top lc op×TopTop. (-)^{(-)} \;\colon\; Top_{lc}^{op} \times Top \longrightarrow Top \,.
Proposition

For XX a topological space and YY a locally compact topological space (in that for each point, each open neighbourhood contains a compact neighbourhood), the topological mapping space X YX^Y from def. is an exponential object, i.e. the functor () Y(-)^Y is right adjoint to the product functor Y×()Y \times (-): there is a natural bijection

Hom Top(Z×Y,X)Hom Top(Z,X Y) Hom_{Top}(Z \times Y, X) \simeq Hom_{Top}(Z, X^Y)

between continuous functions out of any product topological space of YY with any ZTopZ \in Top and continuous functions from ZZ into the mapping space.

A proof is spelled out here (or see e.g. Aguilar-Gitler-Prieto 02, prop. 1.3.1).

Remark

In the context of prop. it is often assumed that YY is also a Hausdorff topological space. But this is not necessary. What assuming Hausdorffness only achieves is that all alternative definitions of “locally compact” become equivalent to the one that is needed for the proposition: for every point, every open neighbourhood contains a compact neighbourhood.

Remark

Proposition fails in general if YY is not locally compact. Therefore the plain category Top of all topological spaces is not a Cartesian closed category.

This is no problem for the construction of the homotopy theory of topological spaces as such, but it becomes a technical nuisance for various constructions that one would like to perform within that homotopy theory. For instance on general pointed topological spaces the smash product is in general not associative.

On the other hand, without changing any of the following discussion one may just pass to a more convenient category of topological spaces such as notably the full subcategory of compactly generated topological spaces Top cgTopTop_{cg} \hookrightarrow Top (def. ) which is Cartesian closed. This we turn to below.

Homotopy

The fundamental concept of homotopy theory is clearly that of homotopy. In the context of topological spaces this is about contiunous deformations of continuous functions parameterized by the standard closed interval:

Definition

Write

I[0,1] I \coloneqq [0,1] \hookrightarrow \mathbb{R}

for the standard topological interval, a compact connected topological subspace of the real line.

Equipped with the canonical inclusion of its two endpoints

**(δ 0,δ 1)I!* \ast \sqcup \ast \stackrel{(\delta_0,\delta_1)}{\longrightarrow} I \stackrel{\exists !}{\longrightarrow} \ast

this is the standard interval object in Top.

For XTopX \in Top, the product topological space X×IX\times I, example , is called the standard cylinder object over XX. The endpoint inclusions of the interval make it factor the codiagonal on XX

X:XX((id,δ 0),(id,δ 1))X×IX. \nabla_X \;\colon\; X \sqcup X \stackrel{((id,\delta_0),(id,\delta_1))}{\longrightarrow} X \times I \longrightarrow X \,.
Definition

For f,g:XYf,g\colon X \longrightarrow Y two continuous functions between topological spaces X,YX,Y, then a left homotopy

η:f Lg \eta \colon f \,\Rightarrow_L\, g

is a continuous function

η:X×IY \eta \;\colon\; X \times I \longrightarrow Y

out of the standard cylinder object over XX, def. , such that this fits into a commuting diagram of the form

X (id,δ 0) f X×I η Y (id,δ 1) g X. \array{ X \\ {}^{\mathllap{(id,\delta_0)}}\downarrow & \searrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ X \times I &\stackrel{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{(id,\delta_1)}}\uparrow & \nearrow_{\mathrlap{g}} \\ X } \,.

(graphics grabbed from J. Tauber here)

Example

Let XX be a topological space and let x,yXx,y \in X be two of its points, regarded as functions x,y:*Xx,y \colon \ast \longrightarrow X from the point to XX. Then a left homotopy, def. , between these two functions is a commuting diagram of the form

* δ 0 x I η X δ 1 y *. \array{ \ast \\ {}^{\mathllap{\delta_0}}\downarrow & \searrow^{\mathrlap{x}} \\ I &\stackrel{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\delta_1}}\uparrow & \nearrow_{\mathrlap{y}} \\ \ast } \,.

This is simply a continuous path in XX whose endpoints are xx and yy.

For instance:

Example

Let

const 0:I*δ 0I const_0 \;\colon\; I \longrightarrow \ast \overset{\delta_0}{\longrightarrow} I

be the continuous function from the standard interval I=[0,1]I = [0,1] to itself that is constant on the value 0. Then there is a left homotopy, def. , from the identity function

η:id Iconst 0 \eta \;\colon\; id_I \Rightarrow const_0

given by

η(x,t)x(1t). \eta(x,t) \coloneqq x(1-t) \,.

A key application of the concept of left homotopy is to the definition of homotopy groups:

Definition

For XX a topological space, then its set π 0(X)\pi_0(X) of connected components, also called the 0-th homotopy set, is the set of left homotopy-equivalence classes (def. ) of points x:*Xx \colon \ast \to X, hence the set of path-connected components of XX (example ). By composition this extends to a functor

π 0:TopSet. \pi_0 \colon Top \longrightarrow Set \,.

For nn \in \mathbb{N}, n1n \geq 1 and for x:*Xx \colon \ast \to X any point, the nnth homotopy group π n(X,x)\pi_n(X,x) of XX at xx is the group

  • whose underlying set is the set of left homotopy-equivalence classes of maps I nXI^n \longrightarrow X that take the boundary of I nI^n to xx and where the left homotopies η\eta are constrained to be constant on the boundary;

  • whose group product operation takes [α:I nX][\alpha \colon I^n \to X] and [β:I nX][\beta \colon I^n \to X] to [αβ][\alpha \cdot \beta] with

αβ:I nI nI n1I n(α,β)X, \alpha \cdot \beta \;\colon\; I^n \stackrel{\simeq}{\longrightarrow} I^n \underset{I^{n-1}}{\sqcup} I^n \stackrel{(\alpha,\beta)}{\longrightarrow} X \,,

where the first map is a homeomorphism from the unit nn-cube to the nn-cube with one side twice the unit length (e.g. (x 1,x 2,x 3,)(2x 1,x 2,x 3,)(x_1, x_2, x_3, \cdots) \mapsto (2 x_1, x_2, x_3, \cdots)).

By composition, this construction extends to a functor

π 1:Top */Grp 1 \pi_{\bullet \geq 1} \;\colon\; Top^{\ast/} \longrightarrow Grp^{\mathbb{N}_{\geq 1}}

from pointed topological spaces to graded groups.

Notice that often one writes the value of this functor on a morphism ff as f *=π (f)f_\ast = \pi_\bullet(f).

Remark

At this point we don’t go further into the abstract reason why def. yields group structure above degree 0, which is that positive dimension spheres are H-cogroup objects. But this is important, for instance in the proof of the Brown representability theorem. See the section Brown representability theorem in Part S.

Definition

A continuous function f:XYf \;\colon\; X \longrightarrow Y is called a homotopy equivalence if there exists a continuous function the other way around, g:YXg \;\colon\; Y \longrightarrow X, and left homotopies, def. , from the two composites to the identity:

η 1:fg Lid Y \eta_1 \;\colon\; f\circ g \Rightarrow_L id_Y

and

η 2:gf Lid X. \eta_2 \;\colon\; g\circ f \Rightarrow_L id_X \,.

If here η 2\eta_2 is constant along II, ff is said to exhibit XX as a deformation retract of YY.

Example

For XX a topological space and X×IX \times I its standard cylinder object of def. , the projection p:X×IXp \colon X \times I \longrightarrow X and the inclusion (id,δ 0):XX×I(id, \delta_0) \colon X \longrightarrow X\times I are homotopy equivalences, def. , and in fact are homotopy inverses to each other:

The composition

X(id,δ 0)X×IpX X \overset{(id,\delta_0)}{\longrightarrow} X\times I \overset{p}{\longrightarrow} X

is immediately the identity on XX (i.e. homotopic to the identity by a trivial homotopy), while the composite

X×IpX(id,δ 0)X×I X \times I \overset{p}{\longrightarrow} X \overset{(id, \delta_0)}{\longrightarrow} X\times I

is homotopic to the identity on X×IX \times I by a homotopy that is pointwise in XX that of example .

Definition

A continuous function f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y is called a weak homotopy equivalence if its image under all the homotopy group functors of def. is an isomorphism, hence if

π 0(f):π 0(X)π 0(Y) \pi_0(f) \;\colon\; \pi_0(X) \stackrel{\simeq}{\longrightarrow} \pi_0(Y)

and for all xXx \in X and all n1n \geq 1

π n(f):π n(X,x)π n(Y,f(x)). \pi_n(f) \;\colon\; \pi_n(X,x) \stackrel{\simeq}{\longrightarrow} \pi_n(Y,f(x)) \,.
Proposition

Every homotopy equivalence, def. , is a weak homotopy equivalence, def. .

In particular a deformation retraction, def. , is a weak homotopy equivalence.

Proof

First observe that for all XX\in Top the inclusion maps

X(id,δ 0)X×I X \overset{(id,\delta_0)}{\longrightarrow} X \times I

into the standard cylinder object, def. , are weak homotopy equivalences: by postcomposition with the contracting homotopy of the interval from example all homotopy groups of X×IX \times I have representatives that factor through this inclusion.

Then given a general homotopy equivalence, apply the homotopy groups functor to the corresponding homotopy diagrams (where for the moment we notationally suppress the choice of basepoint for readability) to get two commuting diagrams

π (X) π (id,δ 0) π (f)π (g) π (X×I) π (η) π (X) π (id,δ 1) π (id) π (X),π (Y) π (id,δ 0) π (g)π (f) π (Y×I) π (η) π (Y) π (id,δ 1) π (id) π (Y). \array{ \pi_\bullet(X) \\ {}^{\mathllap{\pi_\bullet(id,\delta_0)}}\downarrow & \searrow^{\mathrlap{\pi_\bullet(f)\circ \pi_\bullet(g)}} \\ \pi_\bullet(X \times I) &\stackrel{\pi_\bullet(\eta)}{\longrightarrow}& \pi_\bullet(X) \\ {}^{\mathllap{\pi_\bullet(id,\delta_1)}}\uparrow & \nearrow_{\mathrlap{\pi_\bullet(id)}} \\ \pi_\bullet(X) } \;\;\;\;\;\;\; \,, \;\;\;\;\;\;\; \array{ \pi_\bullet(Y) \\ {}^{\mathllap{\pi_\bullet(id,\delta_0)}}\downarrow & \searrow^{\mathrlap{\pi_\bullet(g)\circ \pi_\bullet(f)}} \\ \pi_\bullet(Y \times I) &\stackrel{\pi_\bullet(\eta)}{\longrightarrow}& \pi_\bullet(Y) \\ {}^{\mathllap{\pi_\bullet(id,\delta_1)}}\uparrow & \nearrow_{\mathrlap{\pi_\bullet(id)}} \\ \pi_\bullet(Y) } \,.

By the previous observation, the vertical morphisms here are isomorphisms, and hence these diagrams exhibit π (f)\pi_\bullet(f) as the inverse of π (g)\pi_\bullet(g), hence both as isomorphisms.

Remark

The converse of prop. is not true generally: not every weak homotopy equivalence between topological spaces is a homotopy equivalence. (For an example with full details spelled out see for instance Fritsch, Piccinini: “Cellular Structures in Topology”, p. 289-290).

However, as we will discuss below, it turns out that

  1. every weak homotopy equivalence between CW-complexes is a homotopy equivalence (Whitehead's theorem, cor. );

  2. every topological space is connected by a weak homotopy equivalence to a CW-complex (CW approximation, remark ).

Example

For XTopX\in Top, the projection X×IXX\times I \longrightarrow X from the cylinder object of XX, def. , is a weak homotopy equivalence, def. . This means that the factorization

X:XXX×IX \nabla_X \;\colon\; X \sqcup X \stackrel{}{\hookrightarrow} X\times I \stackrel{\simeq}{\longrightarrow} X

of the codiagonal X\nabla_X in def. , which in general is far from being a monomorphism, may be thought of as factoring it through a monomorphism after replacing XX, up to weak homotopy equivalence, by X×IX\times I.

In fact, further below (prop. ) we see that XXX×IX \sqcup X \to X \times I has better properties than the generic monomorphism has, in particular better homotopy invariant properties: it has the left lifting property against all Serre fibrations EpB E \stackrel{p}{\longrightarrow} B that are also weak homotopy equivalences.

Of course the concept of left homotopy in def. is accompanied by a concept of right homotopy. This we turn to now.

Definition

(path space)

For XX a topological space, its standard topological path space object is the topological path space, hence the mapping space X IX^I, prop. , out of the standard interval II of def. .

Example

The endpoint inclusion into the standard interval, def. , makes the path space X IX^I of def. factor the diagonal on XX through the inclusion of constant paths and the endpoint evaluation of paths:

Δ X:XX I*X IX **IX×X. \Delta_X \;\colon\; X \stackrel{X^{I \to \ast}}{\longrightarrow} X^I \stackrel{X^{\ast \sqcup \ast \to I}}{\longrightarrow} X \times X \,.

This is the formal dual to example . As in that example, below we will see (prop. ) that this factorization has good properties, in that

  1. X I*X^{I \to \ast} is a weak homotopy equivalence;

  2. X **IX^{\ast \sqcup \ast \to I} is a Serre fibration.

So while in general the diagonal Δ X\Delta_X is far from being an epimorphism or even just a Serre fibration, the factorization through the path space object may be thought of as replacing XX, up to weak homotopy equivalence, by its path space, such as to turn its diagonal into a Serre fibration after all.

Definition

For f,g:XYf,g\colon X \longrightarrow Y two continuous functions between topological spaces X,YX,Y, then a right homotopy f Rgf \Rightarrow_R g is a continuous function

η:XY I \eta \;\colon\; X \longrightarrow Y^I

into the path space object of XX, def. , such that this fits into a commuting diagram of the form

Y f X δ 0 X η Y I g Y δ 1 Y. \array{ && Y \\ & {}^{\mathllap{f}}\nearrow & \uparrow^{\mathrlap{X^{\delta_0}}} \\ X &\stackrel{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& Y^I \\ & {}_{\mathllap{g}}\searrow & \downarrow^{\mathrlap{Y^{\delta_1}}} \\ && Y } \,.

Cell complexes

We consider topological spaces that are built consecutively by attaching basic cells.

Definition

Write

I Top{S n1ι nD n} nMor(Top) I_{Top} \coloneqq \left\{ S^{n-1} \stackrel{\iota_n}{\hookrightarrow} D^{n} \right\}_{n \in \mathbb{N}} \; \subset Mor(Top)

for the set of canonical boundary inclusion maps of the standard n-disks, example . This going to be called the set of standard topological generating cofibrations.

Definition

For XTopX \in Top and for nn \in \mathbb{N}, an nn-cell attachment to XX is the pushout (“attaching space”, example ) of a generating cofibration, def.

S n1 ϕ X ι n (po) D n XS n1D n =X ϕD n \array{ S^{n-1} &\stackrel{\phi}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_n}}\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow \\ D^n &\longrightarrow& X \underset{S^{n-1}}{\sqcup} D^n & = X \cup_\phi D^n }

along some continuous function ϕ\phi.

A continuous function f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y is called a topological relative cell complex if it is exhibited by a (possibly infinite) sequence of cell attachments to XX, in that it is a transfinite composition (def. ) of pushouts (example )

iS n i1 X k iι n i (po) iD n i X k+1 \array{ \underset{i}{\coprod} S^{n_i - 1} &\longrightarrow& X_{k} \\ {}^{\mathllap{\underset{i}{\coprod}\iota_{n_i}}}\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow \\ \underset{i}{\coprod} D^{n_i} &\longrightarrow& X_{k+1} }

of coproducts (example ) of generating cofibrations (def. ).

A topological space XX is a cell complex if X\emptyset \longrightarrow X is a relative cell complex.

A relative cell complex is called a finite relative cell complex if it is obtained from a finite number of cell attachments.

A (relative) cell complex is called a (relative) CW-complex if the above transfinite composition is countable

X=X 0 X 1 X 2 f Y=limX \array{ X = X_0 &\longrightarrow& X_1 &\longrightarrow& X_2 &\longrightarrow& \cdots \\ & {}_{\mathllap{f}}\searrow & \downarrow & \swarrow && \cdots \\ && Y = \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim} X_\bullet }

and if X kX_k is obtained from X k1X_{k-1} by attaching cells precisely only of dimension kk.

Remark

Strictly speaking a relative cell complex, def. , is a function f:XYf\colon X \to Y, together with its cell structure, hence together with the information of the pushout diagrams and the transfinite composition of the pushout maps that exhibit it.

In many applications, however, all that matters is that there is some (relative) cell decomposition, and then one tends to speak loosely and mean by a (relative) cell complex only a (relative) topological space that admits some cell decomposition.

The following lemma , together with lemma below are the only two statements of the entire development here that involve the concrete particular nature of topological spaces (“point-set topology”), everything beyond that is general abstract homotopy theory.

Lemma

Assuming the axiom of choice and the law of excluded middle, every compact subspace of a topological cell complex, def. , intersects the interior of a finite number of cells.

(e.g. Hirschhorn 15, section 3.1)

Proof

So let YY be a topological cell complex and CYC \hookrightarrow Y a compact subspace. Define a subset

PY P \subset Y

by choosing one point in the interior of the intersection with CC of each cell of YY that intersects CC.

It is now sufficient to show that PP has no accumulation point. Because, by the compactness of XX, every non-finite subset of CC does have an accumulation point, and hence the lack of such shows that PP is a finite set and hence that CC intersects the interior of finitely many cells of YY.

To that end, let cCc\in C be any point. If cc is a 0-cell in YY, write U c{c}U_c \coloneqq \{c\}. Otherwise write e ce_c for the unique cell of YY that contains cc in its interior. By construction, there is exactly one point of PP in the interior of e ce_c. Hence there is an open neighbourhood cU ce cc \in U_c \subset e_c containing no further points of PP beyond possibly cc itself, if cc happens to be that single point of PP in e ce_c.

It is now sufficient to show that U cU_c may be enlarged to an open subset U˜ c\tilde U_c of YY containing no point of PP, except for possibly cc itself, for that means that cc is not an accumulation point of PP.

To that end, let α c\alpha_c be the ordinal that labels the stage Y α cY_{\alpha_c} of the transfinite composition in the cell complex-presentation of YY at which the cell e ce_c above appears. Let γ\gamma be the ordinal of the full cell complex. Then define the set

T{(β,U)|α cβγ,UopenY β,UY α=U c,UP{,{c}}}, T \coloneqq \left\{ \; (\beta, U) \;|\; \alpha_c \leq \beta \leq \gamma \;\,,\; U \underset{open}{\subset} Y_\beta \;\,,\; U \cap Y_\alpha = U_c \;\,,\; U \cap P \in \{ \emptyset, \{c\} \} \; \right\} \,,

and regard this as a partially ordered set by declaring a partial ordering via

(β 1,U 1)<(β 2,U 2)β 1<β 2,U 2Y β 1=U 1. (\beta_1, U_1) \lt (\beta_2, U_2) \;\;\;\; \Leftrightarrow \;\;\;\; \beta_1 \lt \beta_2 \;\,,\; U_2 \cap Y_{\beta_1} = U_1 \,.

This is set up such that every element (β,U)(\beta, U) of TT with β\beta the maximum value β=γ\beta = \gamma is an extension U˜ c\tilde U_c that we are after.

Observe then that for (β s,U s) sS(\beta_s, U_s)_{s\in S} a chain in (T,<)(T,\lt) (a subset on which the relation <\lt restricts to a total order), it has an upper bound in TT given by the union ( sβ s, sU s)({\cup}_s \beta_s ,\cup_s U_s). Therefore Zorn's lemma applies, saying that (T,<)(T,\lt) contains a maximal element (β max,U max)(\beta_{max}, U_{max}).

Hence it is now sufficient to show that β max=γ\beta_{max} = \gamma. We argue this by showing that assuming β max<γ\beta_{\max}\lt \gamma leads to a contradiction.

So assume β max<γ\beta_{max}\lt \gamma. Then to construct an element of TT that is larger than (β max,U max)(\beta_{max},U_{max}), consider for each cell dd at stage Y β max+1Y_{\beta_{max}+1} its attaching map h d:S n1Y β maxh_d \colon S^{n-1} \to Y_{\beta_{max}} and the corresponding preimage open set h d 1(U max)S n1h_d^{-1}(U_{max})\subset S^{n-1}. Enlarging all these preimages to open subsets of D nD^n (such that their image back in X β max+1X_{\beta_{max}+1} does not contain cc), then (β max,U max)<(β max+1, dU d)(\beta_{max}, U_{max}) \lt (\beta_{max}+1, \cup_d U_d ). This is a contradiction. Hence β max=γ\beta_{max} = \gamma, and we are done.

It is immediate and useful to generalize the concept of topological cell complexes as follows.

Definition

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} any category and for KMor(𝒞)K \subset Mor(\mathcal{C}) any sub-class of its morphisms, a relative KK-cell complex is a morphism in 𝒞\mathcal{C} which is a transfinite composition (def. ) of pushouts of coproducts of morphisms in KK.

Definition

Write

J Top{D n(id,δ 0)D n×I} nMor(Top) J_{Top} \coloneqq \left\{ D^n \stackrel{(id,\delta_0)}{\hookrightarrow} D^n \times I \right\}_{n \in \mathbb{N}} \; \subset Mor(Top)

for the set of inclusions of the topological n-disks, def. , into their cylinder objects, def. , along (for definiteness) the left endpoint inclusion.

These inclusions are similar to the standard topological generating cofibrations I TopI_{Top} of def. , but in contrast to these they are “acyclic” (meaning: trivial on homotopy classes of maps from “cycles” given by n-spheres) in that they are weak homotopy equivalences (by prop. ).

Accordingly, J TopJ_{Top} is to be called the set of standard topological generating acyclic cofibrations.

Lemma

For XX a CW-complex (def. ), then its inclusion X(id,δ 0)X×IX \overset{(id, \delta_0)}{\longrightarrow} X\times I into its standard cylinder (def. ) is a J TopJ_{Top}-relative cell complex (def. , def. ).

Proof

First erect a cylinder over all 0-cells

xX 0D 0 X (po) xX 0D 1 Y 1. \array{ \underset{x \in X_0}{\coprod} D^0 &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow &(po)& \downarrow \\ \underset{x\in X_0}{\coprod} D^1 &\longrightarrow& Y_1 } \,.

Assume then that the cylinder over all nn-cells of XX has been erected using attachment from J TopJ_{Top}. Then the union of any (n+1)(n+1)-cell σ\sigma of XX with the cylinder over its boundary is homeomorphic to D n+1D^{n+1} and is like the cylinder over the cell “with end and interior removed”. Hence via attaching along D n+1D n+1×ID^{n+1} \to D^{n+1}\times I the cylinder over σ\sigma is erected.

Lemma

The maps D nD n×ID^n \hookrightarrow D^n \times I in def. are finite relative cell complexes, def. . In other words, the elements of J TopJ_{Top} are I TopI_{Top}-relative cell complexes.

Proof

There is a homeomorphism

D n = D n (id,δ 0) D n×I D n+1 \array{ D^n & = & D^n \\ {}^{\mathllap{(id,\delta_0)}}\downarrow && \downarrow \\ D^n \times I &\simeq& D^{n+1} }

such that the map on the right is the inclusion of one hemisphere into the boundary n-sphere of D n+1D^{n+1}. This inclusion is the result of attaching two cells:

S n1 ι n D n ι n (po) D n S n = S n id S n ι n+1 (po) D n+1 id D n+1. \array{ S^{n-1} &\overset{\iota_n}{\longrightarrow}& D^n \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_n}}\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow \\ D^n &\longrightarrow& S^{n} \\ && \downarrow^{=} \\ S^n &\overset{id}{\longrightarrow}& S^n \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_{n+1}}}\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow \\ D^{n+1} &\underset{id}{\longrightarrow}& D^{n+1} } \,.

here the top pushout is the one from example .

Lemma

Every J TopJ_{Top}-relative cell complex (def. , def. ) is a weak homotopy equivalence, def. .

Proof

Let XX^=lim βαX βX \longrightarrow \hat X = \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_{\beta \leq \alpha} X_\beta be a J TopJ_{Top}-relative cell complex.

First observe that with the elements D nD n×ID^n \hookrightarrow D^n \times I of J TopJ_{Top} being homotopy equivalences for all nn \in \mathbb{N} (by example ), each of the stages X βX β+1X_{\beta} \longrightarrow X_{\beta + 1} in the relative cell complex is also a homotopy equivalence. We make this fully explicit:

By definition, such a stage is a pushout of the form

iID n i X β iI(id,δ 0) (po) iID n i×I X β+1. \array{ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} &\longrightarrow& X_\beta \\ {}^{\mathllap{\underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} (id, \delta_0)} }\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow \\ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} \times I &\longrightarrow& X_{\beta + 1} } \,.

Then the fact that the projections p n i:D n i×ID n ip_{n_i} \colon D^{n_i} \times I \to D^{n_i} are strict left inverses to the inclusions (id,δ 0)(id, \delta_0) gives a commuting square of the form

iID n i X β iI(id,δ 0) id iID n i×I iIp n i iID n i X β \array{ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} &\longrightarrow& X_\beta \\ {}^{\mathllap{\underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} (id, \delta_0)} }\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{id}} \\ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} \times I \\ {}^{\mathllap{\underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} p_{n_i} }}\downarrow && \downarrow \\ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} &\longrightarrow& X_\beta }

and so the universal property of the colimit (pushout) X β+1X_{\beta + 1} gives a factorization of the identity morphism on the right through X β+1X_{\beta + 1}

iID n i X β iI(id,δ 0) iID n i×I X β+1 iIp n i iID n i X β \array{ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} &\longrightarrow& X_\beta \\ {}^{\mathllap{\underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} (id, \delta_0)} }\downarrow && \downarrow^{} \\ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} \times I &\longrightarrow& X_{\beta + 1} \\ {}^{\mathllap{\underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} p_{n_i} }}\downarrow && \downarrow \\ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} &\longrightarrow& X_\beta }

which exhibits X β+1X βX_{\beta + 1} \to X_\beta as a strict left inverse to X βX β+1X_{\beta} \to X_{\beta + 1}. Hence it is now sufficient to show that this is also a homotopy right inverse.

To that end, let

η n i:D n i×ID n i×I \eta_{n_i} \colon D^{n_i}\times I \longrightarrow D^{n_i} \times I

be the left homotopy that exhibits p n ip_{n_i} as a homotopy right inverse to p n ip_{n_i} by example . For each t[0,1]t \in [0,1] consider the commuting square

iID n i X β iID n i×I X β+1 η n i(,t) id iID n i×I X β+1. \array{ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} &\longrightarrow& X_\beta \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} \times I && X_{\beta + 1} \\ {}^{\mathllap{\eta_{n_i}(-,t)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{id}} \\ \underset{i \in I}{\sqcup} D^{n_i} \times I &\longrightarrow& X_{\beta + 1} } \,.

Regarded as a cocone under the span in the top left, the universal property of the colimit (pushout) X β+1X_{\beta + 1} gives a continuous function

η(,t):X β+1X β+1 \eta(-,t) \;\colon\; X_{\beta + 1} \longrightarrow X_{\beta + 1}

for each t[0,1]t \in [0,1]. For t=0t = 0 this construction reduces to the provious one in that η(,0):X β+1X βX β+1\eta(-,0) \colon X_{\beta +1 } \to X_{\beta} \to X_{\beta + 1} is the composite which we need to homotope to the identity; while η(,1)\eta(-,1) is the identity. Since η(,t)\eta(-,t) is clearly also continuous in tt it constitutes a continuous function

η:X β+1×IX β+1 \eta \;\colon\; X_{\beta + 1}\times I \longrightarrow X_{\beta + 1}

which exhibits the required left homotopy.

So far this shows that each stage X βX β+1X_{\beta} \to X_{\beta+1} in the transfinite composition defining X^\hat X is a homotopy equivalence, hence, by prop. , a weak homotopy equivalence.

This means that all morphisms in the following diagram (notationally suppressing basepoints and showing only the finite stages)

π n(X) π n(X 1) π n(X 2) π n(X 3) lim απ n(X α) \array{ \pi_n(X) &\overset{\simeq}{\longrightarrow}& \pi_n(X_1) &\overset{\simeq}{\longrightarrow}& \pi_n(X_2) &\overset{\simeq}{\longrightarrow}& \pi_n(X_3) &\overset{\simeq}{\longrightarrow}& \cdots \\ & {}_{\mathllap{\simeq}}\searrow & \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\simeq}} & \swarrow_{\mathrlap{\simeq}} & \cdots \\ && \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_\alpha \pi_n(X_\alpha) }

are isomorphisms.

Moreover, lemma gives that every representative and every null homotopy of elements in π n(X^)\pi_n(\hat X) already exists at some finite stage X kX_k. This means that also the universally induced morphism

lim απ n(X α)π n(X^) \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_\alpha \pi_n(X_\alpha) \overset{\simeq}{\longrightarrow} \pi_n(\hat X)

is an isomorphism. Hence the composite π n(X)π n(X^)\pi_n(X) \overset{\simeq}{\longrightarrow} \pi_n(\hat X) is an isomorphism.

Fibrations

Given a relative CC-cell complex ι:XY\iota \colon X \to Y, def. , it is typically interesting to study the extension problem along ff, i.e. to ask which topological spaces EE are such that every continuous function f:XEf\colon X \longrightarrow E has an extension f˜\tilde f along ι\iota

X f E ι f˜ Y. \array{ X &\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow}& E \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota}}\downarrow & \nearrow_{\mathrlap{\exists \tilde f}} \\ Y } \,.

If such extensions exists, it means that EE is sufficiently “spread out” with respect to the maps in CC. More generally one considers this extension problem fiberwise, i.e. with both EE and YY (hence also XX) equipped with a map to some base space BB:

Definition

Given a category 𝒞\mathcal{C} and a sub-class CMor(𝒞)C \subset Mor(\mathcal{C}) of its morphisms, then a morphism p:EBp \colon E \longrightarrow B in 𝒞\mathcal{C} is said to have the right lifting property against the morphisms in CC if every commuting diagram in 𝒞\mathcal{C} of the form

X E c p Y B, \array{ X &\longrightarrow& E \\ {}^{\mathllap{c}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ Y &\longrightarrow& B } \,,

with cCc \in C, has a lift hh, in that it may be completed to a commuting diagram of the form

X E c h p Y B. \array{ X &\longrightarrow& E \\ {}^{\mathllap{c}}\downarrow &{}^{\mathllap{h}}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ Y &\longrightarrow& B } \,.

We will also say that pp is a CC-injective morphism if it satisfies the right lifting property against CC.

Definition

A continuous function p:EBp \colon E \longrightarrow B is called a Serre fibration if it is a J TopJ_{Top}-injective morphism; i.e. if it has the right lifting property, def. , against all topological generating acylic cofibrations, def. ; hence if for every commuting diagram of continuous functions of the form

D n E (id,δ 0) p D n×I B, \array{ D^n &\longrightarrow& E \\ {}^{\mathllap{(id,\delta_0)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ D^n\times I &\longrightarrow& B } \,,

has a lift hh, in that it may be completed to a commuting diagram of the form

D n E (id,δ 0) h p D n×I B. \array{ D^n &\longrightarrow& E \\ {}^{\mathllap{(id,\delta_0)}}\downarrow &{}^{\mathllap{h}}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ D^n\times I &\longrightarrow& B } \,.
Remark

Def. says, in view of the definition of left homotopy, that a Serre fibration pp is a map with the property that given a left homotopy, def. , between two functions into its codomain, and given a lift of one the two functions through pp, then also the homotopy between the two lifts. Therefore the condition on a Serre fibration is also called the homotopy lifting property for maps whose domain is an n-disk.

More generally one may ask functions pp to have such homotopy lifting property for functions with arbitrary domain. These are called Hurewicz fibrations.

Remark

The precise shape of D nD^n and D n×ID^n \times I in def. turns out not to actually matter much for the nature of Serre fibrations. We will eventually find below (prop. ) that what actually matters here is only that the inclusions D nD n×ID^n \hookrightarrow D^n \times I are relative cell complexes (lemma ) and weak homotopy equivalences (prop. ) and that all of these may be generated from them in a suitable way.

But for simple special cases this is readily seen directly, too. Notably we could replace the n-disks in def. with any homeomorphic topological space. A choice important in the comparison to the classical model structure on simplicial sets (below) is to instead take the topological n-simplices Δ n\Delta^n. Hence a Serre fibration is equivalently characterized as having lifts in all diagrams of the form

Δ n E (id,δ 0) p Δ n×I B. \array{ \Delta^n &\longrightarrow& E \\ {}^{\mathllap{(id,\delta_0)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ \Delta^n\times I &\longrightarrow& B } \,.

Other deformations of the nn-disks are useful in computations, too. For instance there is a homeomorphism from the nn-disk to its “cylinder with interior and end removed”, formally:

(D n×{0})(D n×I) D n D n×I D n×I \array{ (D^n \times \{0\})\cup (\partial D^n \times I) &\simeq& D^n \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ D^n \times I &\simeq& D^n\times I }

and hence ff is a Serre fibration equivalently also if it admits lifts in all diagrams of the form

(D n×{0})(D n×I) E (id,δ 0) p D n×I B. \array{ (D^n \times \{0\})\cup (\partial D^n \times I) &\longrightarrow& E \\ {}^{\mathllap{(id,\delta_0)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ D^n\times I &\longrightarrow& B } \,.

The following is a general fact about closure of morphisms defined by lifting properties which we prove in generality below as prop. .

Proposition

A Serre fibration, def. has the right lifting property against all retracts (see remark ) of J TopJ_{Top}-relative cell complexes (def. , def. ).

The following statement is foreshadowing the long exact sequences of homotopy groups (below) induced by any fiber sequence, the full version of which we come to below (example ) after having developed more of the abstract homotopy theory.

Proposition

Let f:XYf\colon X \longrightarrow Y be a Serre fibration, def. , let y:*Yy \colon \ast \to Y be any point and write

F yιXfY F_y \overset{\iota}{\hookrightarrow} X \overset{f}{\longrightarrow} Y

for the fiber inclusion over that point. Then for every choice x:*Xx \colon \ast \to X of lift of the point yy through ff, the induced sequence of homotopy groups

π (F y,x)ι *π (X,x)f *π (Y) \pi_{\bullet}(F_y, x) \overset{\iota_\ast}{\longrightarrow} \pi_\bullet(X, x) \overset{f_\ast}{\longrightarrow} \pi_\bullet(Y)

is exact, in that the kernel of f *f_\ast is canonically identified with the image of ι *\iota_\ast:

ker(f *)im(ι *). ker(f_\ast) \simeq im(\iota_\ast) \,.
Proof

It is clear that the image of ι *\iota_\ast is in the kernel of f *f_\ast (every sphere in F yXF_y\hookrightarrow X becomes constant on yy, hence contractible, when sent forward to YY).

For the converse, let [α]π (X,x)[\alpha]\in \pi_{\bullet}(X,x) be represented by some α:S n1X\alpha \colon S^{n-1} \to X. Assume that [α][\alpha] is in the kernel of f *f_\ast. This means equivalently that α\alpha fits into a commuting diagram of the form

S n1 α X f D n κ Y, \array{ S^{n-1} &\overset{\alpha}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ D^n &\overset{\kappa}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,,

where κ\kappa is the contracting homotopy witnessing that f *[α]=0f_\ast[\alpha] = 0.

Now since xx is a lift of yy, there exists a left homotopy

η:κconst y \eta \;\colon\; \kappa \Rightarrow const_y

as follows:

S n1 α X ι n f D n κ Y (id,δ 1) id D n (id,δ 0) D n×I η Y * y Y \array{ && S^{n-1} &\overset{\alpha}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ && {}^{\mathllap{\iota_n}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ && D^n &\overset{\kappa}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(id,\delta_1)}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{id}} \\ D^n &\overset{(id,\delta_0)}{\longrightarrow}& D^n \times I &\overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ \downarrow && && \downarrow \\ \ast && \overset{y}{\longrightarrow} && Y }

(for instance: regard D nD^n as embedded in n\mathbb{R}^n such that 0 n0 \in \mathbb{R}^n is identified with the basepoint on the boundary of D nD^n and set η(v,t)κ(tv)\eta(\vec v,t) \coloneqq \kappa(t \vec v)).

The pasting of the top two squares that have appeared this way is equivalent to the following commuting square

S n1 α X (id,δ 1) f S n1×I (ι n,id) D n×I η Y. \array{ S^{n-1} &\longrightarrow& &\overset{\alpha}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{(id,\delta_1)}}\downarrow && && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ S^{n-1} \times I &\overset{(\iota_n, id)}{\longrightarrow}& D^n \times I &\overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

Because ff is a Serre fibration and by lemma and prop. , this has a lift

η˜:S n1×IX. \tilde \eta \;\colon\; S^{n-1} \times I \longrightarrow X \,.

Notice that η˜\tilde \eta is a basepoint preserving left homotopy from α=η˜| 1\alpha = \tilde \eta|_1 to some αη˜| 0\alpha' \coloneqq \tilde \eta|_0. Being homotopic, they represent the same element of π n1(X,x)\pi_{n-1}(X,x):

[α]=[α]. [\alpha'] = [\alpha] \,.

But the new representative α\alpha' has the special property that its image in YY is not just trivializable, but trivialized: combining η˜\tilde \eta with the previous diagram shows that it sits in the following commuting diagram

α: S n1 (id,δ 0) S n1×I η˜ X ι n (ι n,id) f D n (id,δ 0) D n×I η Y * y Y. \array{ \alpha' \colon & S^{n-1} &\overset{(id,\delta_0)}{\longrightarrow}& S^{n-1}\times I &\overset{\tilde \eta}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ & \downarrow^{\iota_n} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(\iota_n,id)}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ & D^n &\overset{(id,\delta_0)}{\longrightarrow}& D^n \times I &\overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ & \downarrow && && \downarrow \\ & \ast && \overset{y}{\longrightarrow} && Y } \,.

The commutativity of the outer square says that f *αf_\ast \alpha' is constant, hence that α\alpha' is entirely contained in the fiber F yF_y. Said more abstractly, the universal property of fibers gives that α\alpha' factors through F yιXF_y\overset{\iota}{\hookrightarrow} X, hence that [α]=[α][\alpha'] = [\alpha] is in the image of ι *\iota_\ast.

The following lemma , together with lemma above, are the only two statements of the entire development here that crucially involve the concrete particular nature of topological spaces (“point-set topology”), everything beyond that is general abstract homotopy theory.

Lemma

The continuous functions with the right lifting property, def. against the set I Top={S n1D n}I_{Top} = \{S^{n-1}\hookrightarrow D^n\} of topological generating cofibrations, def. , are precisely those which are both weak homotopy equivalences, def. as well as Serre fibrations, def. .

Proof

We break this up into three sub-statements:

A) I TopI_{Top}-injective morphisms are in particular weak homotopy equivalences

Let p:X^Xp \colon \hat X \to X have the right lifting property against I TopI_{Top}

S n1 X^ ι n p D n X \array{ S^{n-1} &\longrightarrow & \hat X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_n}}\downarrow &{}^{\mathllap{\exists}}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ D^n &\longrightarrow& X }

We check that the lifts in these diagrams exhibit π (f)\pi_\bullet(f) as being an isomorphism on all homotopy groups, def. :

For n=0n = 0 the existence of these lifts says that every point of XX is in the image of pp, hence that π 0(X^)π 0(X)\pi_0(\hat X) \to \pi_0(X) is surjective. Let then S 0=**X^S^0 = \ast \coprod \ast \longrightarrow \hat X be a map that hits two connected components, then the existence of the lift says that if they have the same image in π 0(X)\pi_0(X) then they were already the same connected component in X^\hat X. Hence π 0(X^)π 0(X)\pi_0(\hat X)\to \pi_0(X) is also injective and hence is a bijection.

Similarly, for n1n \geq 1, if S nX^S^n \to \hat X represents an element in π n(X^)\pi_n(\hat X) that becomes trivial in π n(X)\pi_n(X), then the existence of the lift says that it already represented the trivial element itself. Hence π n(X^)π n(X)\pi_n(\hat X) \to \pi_n(X) has trivial kernel and so is injective.

Finally, to see that π n(X^)π n(X)\pi_n(\hat X) \to \pi_n(X) is also surjective, hence bijective, observe that every elements in π n(X)\pi_n(X) is equivalently represented by a commuting diagram of the form

S n1 * X^ D n X = X \array{ S^{n-1} &\longrightarrow& \ast &\longrightarrow& \hat X \\ \downarrow && \downarrow && \downarrow \\ D^n &\longrightarrow& X &=& X }

and so here the lift gives a representative of a preimage in π n(X^)\pi_{n}(\hat X).

B) I TopI_{Top}-injective morphisms are in particular Serre fibrations

By an immediate closure property of lifting problems (we spell this out in generality as prop. , cor. below) an I TopI_{Top}-injective morphism has the right lifting property against all relative cell complexes, and hence, by lemma , it is also a J TopJ_{Top}-injective morphism, hence a Serre fibration.

C) Acyclic Serre fibrations are in particular I TopI_{Top}-injective morphisms

(Hirschhorn 15, section 6).

Let f:XYf\colon X \to Y be a Serre fibration that induces isomorphisms on homotopy groups. In degree 0 this means that ff is an isomorphism on connected components, and this means that there is a lift in every commuting square of the form

S 1= X f D 0=* Y \array{ S^{-1} = \emptyset &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ D^0 = \ast &\longrightarrow& Y }

(this is π 0(f)\pi_0(f) being surjective) and in every commuting square of the form

S 0 X ι 0 f D 1=* Y \array{ S^0 &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_0}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ D^1 = \ast &\longrightarrow& Y }

(this is π 0(f)\pi_0(f) being injective). Hence we are reduced to showing that for n2n \geq 2 every diagram of the form

S n1 α X ι n f D n κ Y \array{ S^{n-1} &\overset{\alpha}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_n}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ D^n &\overset{\kappa}{\longrightarrow}& Y }

has a lift.

To that end, pick a basepoint on S n1S^{n-1} and write xx and yy for its images in XX and YY, respectively

Then the diagram above expresses that f *[α]=0π n1(Y,y)f_\ast[\alpha] = 0 \in \pi_{n-1}(Y,y) and hence by assumption on ff it follows that [α]=0π n1(X,x)[\alpha] = 0 \in \pi_{n-1}(X,x), which in turn mean that there is κ\kappa' making the upper triangle of our lifting problem commute:

S n1 α X ι n κ D n. \array{ S^{n-1} &\overset{\alpha}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_n}}\downarrow & \nearrow_{\mathrlap{\kappa'}} \\ D^n } \,.

It is now sufficient to show that any such κ\kappa' may be deformed to a ρ\rho' which keeps making this upper triangle commute but also makes the remaining lower triangle commute.

To that end, notice that by the commutativity of the original square, we already have at least this commuting square:

S n1 ι n D n ι n fκ D n κ Y. \array{ S^{n-1} &\overset{\iota_n}{\longrightarrow}& D^n \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_n}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f \circ \kappa'}} \\ D^n &\underset{\kappa}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

This induces the universal map (κ,fκ)(\kappa,f \circ \kappa') from the pushout of its cospan in the top left, which is the n-sphere (see this example):

S n1 ι n D n ι n (po) fκ D n κ S n (κ,fκ) Y. \array{ S^{n-1} &\overset{\iota_n}{\longrightarrow}& D^n \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_n}}\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f \circ \kappa'}} \\ D^n &\underset{\kappa}{\longrightarrow}& S^n \\ && & \searrow^{(\kappa,f \circ \kappa')} \\ && && Y } \,.

This universal morphism represents an element of the nnth homotopy group:

[(κ,fκ)]π n(Y,y). [(\kappa,f \circ \kappa')] \in \pi_n(Y,y) \,.

By assumption that ff is a weak homotopy equivalence, there is a [ρ]π n(X,x)[\rho] \in \pi_{n}(X,x) with

f *[ρ]=[(κ,fκ)] f_\ast [\rho] = [(\kappa,f \circ \kappa')]

hence on representatives there is a lift up to homotopy

X ρ f S n (κ,fκ) Y. \array{ && X \\ &{}^{\mathllap{\rho}}\nearrow_{\mathrlap{\Downarrow}} & \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ S^n &\underset{(\kappa,f\circ \kappa')}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

Morever, we may always find ρ\rho of the form (ρ,κ)(\rho', \kappa') for some ρ:D nX\rho' \colon D^n \to X. (“Paste κ\kappa' to the reverse of ρ\rho.”)

Consider then the map

S n(fρ,κ)Y S^n \overset{(f\circ \rho', \kappa)}{\longrightarrow} Y

and observe that this represents the trivial class:

[(fρ,κ)] =[(fρ,fκ)]+[(fκ,κ)] =f *[(ρ,κ)]=[ρ]+[(fκ,κ)] =[(κ,fκ)]+[(fκ,κ)] =0. \begin{aligned} [(f \circ \rho', \kappa)] & = [(f\circ \rho', f\circ \kappa')] + [(f\circ \kappa', \kappa)] \\ & = f_\ast \underset{= [\rho]}{\underbrace{[(\rho',\kappa')]}} + [(f\circ \kappa', \kappa)] \\ & = [(\kappa,f \circ \kappa')] + [(f\circ \kappa', \kappa)] \\ & = 0 \end{aligned} \,.

This means equivalently that there is a homotopy

ϕ:fρκ \phi \; \colon \; f\circ \rho' \Rightarrow \kappa

fixing the boundary of the nn-disk.

Hence if we denote homotopy by double arrows, then we have now achieved the following situation

S n1 α X ι n ρ ϕ f D n Y \array{ S^{n-1} &\overset{\alpha}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_n}}\downarrow & {}^{\rho'}\nearrow_{\Downarrow^{\phi}} & \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ D^n &\longrightarrow& Y }

and it now suffices to show that ϕ\phi may be lifted to a homotopy of just ρ\rho', fixing the boundary, for then the resulting homotopic ρ\rho'' is the desired lift.

To that end, notice that the condition that ϕ:D n×IY\phi \colon D^n \times I \to Y fixes the boundary of the nn-disk means equivalently that it extends to a morphism

S n1S n1×ID n×I(fα,ϕ)Y S^{n-1} \underset{S^{n-1}\times I}{\sqcup} D^n \times I \overset{(f\circ \alpha,\phi)}{\longrightarrow} Y

out of the pushout that identifies in the cylinder over D nD^n all points lying over the boundary. Hence we are reduced to finding a lift in

D n ρ X f S n1S n1×ID n×I (fα,ϕ) Y. \array{ D^n &\overset{\rho'}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ S^{n-1}\underset{S^{n-1}\times I}{\sqcup} D^n \times I &\overset{(f\circ \alpha,\phi)}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

But inspection of the left map reveals that it is homeomorphic again to D nD n×ID^n \to D^n \times I, and hence the lift does indeed exist.

Abstract homotopy theory

In the above we discussed three classes of continuous functions between topological spaces

  1. weak homotopy equivalences;

  2. relative cell complexes;

  3. Serre fibrations

and we saw first aspects of their interplay via lifting properties.

A fundamental insight due to (Quillen 67) is that in fact all constructions in homotopy theory are elegantly expressible via just the abstract interplay of these classes of morphisms. This was distilled in (Quillen 67) into a small set of axioms called a model category structure (because it serves to make all objects be models for homotopy types.)

This abstract homotopy theory is the royal road for handling any flavor of homotopy theory, in particular the stable homotopy theory that we are after in Part 1. Here we discuss the basic constructions and facts in abstract homotopy theory, then below we conclude this Introduction to Homotopy Theory by showing that topological spaces equipped with the above system of classes continuous functions is indeed an example of abstract homotopy theory in this sense.


Literature (Dwyer-Spalinski 95)


Definition

A category with weak equivalences is

  1. a category 𝒞\mathcal{C};

  2. a sub-class WMor(𝒞)W \subset Mor(\mathcal{C}) of its morphisms;

such that

  1. WW contains all the isomorphisms of 𝒞\mathcal{C};

  2. WW is closed under two-out-of-three: in every commuting diagram in 𝒞\mathcal{C} of the form

    Y X Z \array{ && Y \\ & \nearrow&& \searrow \\ X && \longrightarrow && Z }

    if two of the three morphisms are in WW, then so is the third.

Remark

It turns out that a category with weak equivalences, def. , already determines a homotopy theory: the one given given by universally forcing weak equivalences to become actual homotopy equivalences. This may be made precise and is called the simplicial localization of a category with weak equivalences (Dwyer-Kan 80a, Dwyer-Kan 80b, Dwyer-Kan 80c). However, without further auxiliary structure, these simplicial localizations are in general intractable. The further axioms of a model category serve the sole purpose of making the universal homotopy theory induced by a category with weak equivalences be tractable:

Definition

A model category is

  1. a category 𝒞\mathcal{C} with all limits and colimits (def. );

  2. three sub-classes W,Fib,CofMor(𝒞)W, Fib, Cof \subset Mor(\mathcal{C}) of its morphisms;

such that

  1. the class WW makes 𝒞\mathcal{C} into a category with weak equivalences, def. ;

  2. The pairs (WCof,Fib)(W \cap Cof\;,\; Fib) and (Cof,WFib)(Cof\;,\; W\cap Fib) are both weak factorization systems, def. .

One says:

The form of def. is due to (Joyal, def. E.1.2). It implies various other conditions that (Quillen 67) demands explicitly, see prop. and prop. below.

We now dicuss the concept of weak factorization systems appearing in def. .

Factorization systems

Definition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be any category. Given a diagram in 𝒞\mathcal{C} of the form

X f Y p B \array{ X &\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{p}}\downarrow \\ B }

then an extension of the morphism ff along the morphism pp is a completion to a commuting diagram of the form

X f Y p f˜ B. \array{ X &\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{p}}\downarrow & \nearrow_{\mathrlap{\tilde f}} \\ B } \,.

Dually, given a diagram of the form

A p X f Y \array{ && A \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ X &\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y }

then a lift of ff through pp is a completion to a commuting diagram of the form

A f˜ p X f Y. \array{ && A \\ &{}^{\mathllap{\tilde f}}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ X &\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

Combining these cases: given a commuting square

X 1 f 1 Y 1 p l p r X 2 f 1 Y 2 \array{ X_1 &\stackrel{f_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y_1 \\ {}^{\mathllap{p_l}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_r}} \\ X_2 &\stackrel{f_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y_2 }

then a lifting in the diagram is a completion to a commuting diagram of the form

X 1 f 1 Y 1 p l p r X 2 f 1 Y 2. \array{ X_1 &\stackrel{f_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y_1 \\ {}^{\mathllap{p_l}}\downarrow &\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_r}} \\ X_2 &\stackrel{f_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y_2 } \,.

Given a sub-class of morphisms KMor(𝒞)K \subset Mor(\mathcal{C}), then

  • a morphism p rp_r as above is said to have the right lifting property against KK or to be a KK-injective morphism if in all square diagrams with p rp_r on the right and any p lKp_l \in K on the left a lift exists.

dually:

  • a morphism p lp_l is said to have the left lifting property against KK or to be a KK-projective morphism if in all square diagrams with p lp_l on the left and any p rKp_r \in K on the right a lift exists.
Definition

A weak factorization system (WFS) on a category 𝒞\mathcal{C} is a pair (Proj,Inj)(Proj,Inj) of classes of morphisms of 𝒞\mathcal{C} such that

  1. Every morphism f:XYf \colon X\to Y of 𝒞\mathcal{C} may be factored as the composition of a morphism in ProjProj followed by one in InjInj

    f:XProjZInjY. f\;\colon\; X \overset{\in Proj}{\longrightarrow} Z \overset{\in Inj}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.
  2. The classes are closed under having the lifting property, def. , against each other:

    1. ProjProj is precisely the class of morphisms having the left lifting property against every morphisms in InjInj;

    2. InjInj is precisely the class of morphisms having the right lifting property against every morphisms in ProjProj.

Definition

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} a category, a functorial factorization of the morphisms in 𝒞\mathcal{C} is a functor

fact:𝒞 Δ[1]𝒞 Δ[2] fact \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}^{\Delta[1]} \longrightarrow \mathcal{C}^{\Delta[2]}

which is a section of the composition functor d 1:𝒞 Δ[2]𝒞 Δ[1]d_1 \;\colon \;\mathcal{C}^{\Delta[2]}\to \mathcal{C}^{\Delta[1]}.

Remark

In def. we are using the following standard notation, see at simplex category and at nerve of a category:

Write [1]={01}[1] = \{0 \to 1\} and [2]={012}[2] = \{0 \to 1 \to 2\} for the ordinal numbers, regarded as posets and hence as categories. The arrow category Arr(𝒞)Arr(\mathcal{C}) is equivalently the functor category 𝒞 Δ[1]Funct(Δ[1],𝒞)\mathcal{C}^{\Delta[1]} \coloneqq Funct(\Delta[1], \mathcal{C}), while 𝒞 Δ[2]Funct(Δ[2],𝒞)\mathcal{C}^{\Delta[2]}\coloneqq Funct(\Delta[2], \mathcal{C}) has as objects pairs of composable morphisms in 𝒞\mathcal{C}. There are three injective functors δ i:[1][2]\delta_i \colon [1] \rightarrow [2], where δ i\delta_i omits the index ii in its image. By precomposition, this induces functors d i:𝒞 Δ[2]𝒞 Δ[1]d_i \colon \mathcal{C}^{\Delta[2]} \longrightarrow \mathcal{C}^{\Delta[1]}. Here

  • d 1d_1 sends a pair of composable morphisms to their composition;

  • d 2d_2 sends a pair of composable morphisms to the first morphisms;

  • d 0d_0 sends a pair of composable morphisms to the second morphisms.

Definition

A weak factorization system, def. , is called a functorial weak factorization system if the factorization of morphisms may be chosen to be a functorial factorization factfact, def. , i.e. such that d 2factd_2 \circ fact lands in ProjProj and d 0factd_0\circ fact in InjInj.

Remark

Not all weak factorization systems are functorial, def. , although most (including those produced by the small object argument (prop. below), with due care) are.

Proposition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a category and let KMor(𝒞)K\subset Mor(\mathcal{C}) be a class of morphisms. Write KProjK Proj and KInjK Inj, respectively, for the sub-classes of KK-projective morphisms and of KK-injective morphisms, def. . Then:

  1. Both classes contain the class of isomorphisms of 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

  2. Both classes are closed under composition in 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

    KProjK Proj is also closed under transfinite composition.

  3. Both classes are closed under forming retracts in the arrow category 𝒞 Δ[1]\mathcal{C}^{\Delta[1]} (see remark ).

  4. KProjK Proj is closed under forming pushouts of morphisms in 𝒞\mathcal{C} (“cobase change”).

    KInjK Inj is closed under forming pullback of morphisms in 𝒞\mathcal{C} (“base change”).

  5. KProjK Proj is closed under forming coproducts in 𝒞 Δ[1]\mathcal{C}^{\Delta[1]}.

    KInjK Inj is closed under forming products in 𝒞 Δ[1]\mathcal{C}^{\Delta[1]}.

Proof

We go through each item in turn.

containing isomorphisms

Given a commuting square

A f X Iso i p B g Y \array{ A &\overset{f}{\rightarrow}& X \\ {}_{\mathllap{\in Iso}}^{\mathllap{i}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ B &\underset{g}{\longrightarrow}& Y }

with the left morphism an isomorphism, then a lift is given by using the inverse of this isomorphism fi 1{}^{{f \circ i^{-1}}}\nearrow. Hence in particular there is a lift when pKp \in K and so iKProji \in K Proj. The other case is formally dual.

closure under composition

Given a commuting square of the form

A X KInj p 1 K i KInj p 2 B Y \array{ A &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_1}}_{\mathrlap{\in K Inj}} \\ {}^{\mathllap{i}}_{\mathllap{\in K}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_2}}_{\mathrlap{\in K Inj}} \\ B &\longrightarrow& Y }

consider its pasting decomposition as

A X KInj p 1 K i KInj p 2 B Y. \array{ A &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow &\searrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_1}}_{\mathrlap{\in K Inj}} \\ {}^{\mathllap{i}}_{\mathllap{\in K}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_2}}_{\mathrlap{\in K Inj}} \\ B &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.

Now the bottom commuting square has a lift, by assumption. This yields another pasting decomposition

A X K i KInj p 1 KInj p 2 B Y \array{ A &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{i}}_{\mathllap{\in K}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_1}}_{\mathrlap{\in K Inj}} \\ \downarrow &\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_2}}_{\mathrlap{\in K Inj}} \\ B &\longrightarrow& Y }

and now the top commuting square has a lift by assumption. This is now equivalently a lift in the total diagram, showing that p 1p 1p_1\circ p_1 has the right lifting property against KK and is hence in KInjK Inj. The case of composing two morphisms in KProjK Proj is formally dual. From this the closure of KProjK Proj under transfinite composition follows since the latter is given by colimits of sequential composition and successive lifts against the underlying sequence as above constitutes a cocone, whence the extension of the lift to the colimit follows by its universal property (cf. eg. Hirschhorn (2002), Lem. 10.3.1).

closure under retracts

Let jj be the retract of an iKProji \in K Proj, i.e. let there be a commuting diagram of the form.

id A: A C A j KProj i j id B: B D B. \array{ id_A \colon & A &\longrightarrow& C &\longrightarrow& A \\ & \downarrow^{\mathrlap{j}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{i}}_{\mathrlap{\in K Proj}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{j}} \\ id_B \colon & B &\longrightarrow& D &\longrightarrow& B } \,.

Then for

A X j K f B Y \array{ A &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{j}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in K}} \\ B &\longrightarrow& Y }

a commuting square, it is equivalent to its pasting composite with that retract diagram

A C A X j KProj i j K f B D B Y. \array{ A &\longrightarrow& C &\longrightarrow& A &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{j}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{i}}_{\mathrlap{\in K Proj}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{j}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in K}} \\ B &\longrightarrow& D &\longrightarrow& B &\longrightarrow & Y } \,.

Here the pasting composite of the two squares on the right has a lift, by assumption:

A C A X j i K f B D B Y. \array{ A &\longrightarrow& C &\longrightarrow& A &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{j}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{i}}_{} && \nearrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in K}} \\ B &\longrightarrow& D &\longrightarrow& B &\longrightarrow & Y } \,.

By composition, this is also a lift in the total outer rectangle, hence in the original square. Hence jj has the left lifting property against all pKp \in K and hence is in KProjK Proj. The other case is formally dual.

closure under pushout and pullback

Let pKInjp \in K Inj and and let

Z× fX X f *p p Z f Y \array{ Z \times_f X &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{{f^* p}}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ Z &\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow} & Y }

be a pullback diagram in 𝒞\mathcal{C}. We need to show that f *pf^* p has the right lifting property with respect to all iKi \in K. So let

A Z× fX K i f *p B g Z \array{ A &\longrightarrow& Z \times_f X \\ {}^{\mathllap{i}}_{\mathllap{\in K}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\mathrlap{f^* p}}} \\ B &\stackrel{g}{\longrightarrow}& Z }

be a commuting square. We need to construct a diagonal lift of that square. To that end, first consider the pasting composite with the pullback square from above to obtain the commuting diagram

A Z× fX X i f *p p B g Z f Y. \array{ A &\longrightarrow& Z \times_f X &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{i}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f^* p}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ B &\stackrel{g}{\longrightarrow}& Z &\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

By the right lifting property of pp, there is a diagonal lift of the total outer diagram

A X i (fg)^ p B fg Y. \array{ A &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{i}} &{}^{\hat {(f g)}}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ B &\stackrel{f g}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

By the universal property of the pullback this gives rise to the lift g^\hat g in

Z× fX X g^ f *p p B g Z f Y. \array{ && Z \times_f X &\longrightarrow& X \\ &{}^{\hat g} \nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f^* p}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ B &\stackrel{g}{\longrightarrow}& Z &\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

In order for g^\hat g to qualify as the intended lift of the total diagram, it remains to show that

A Z× fX i g^ B \array{ A &\longrightarrow& Z \times_f X \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{i}} & {}^{\hat g}\nearrow \\ B }

commutes. To do so we notice that we obtain two cones with tip AA:

  • one is given by the morphisms

    1. AZ× fXXA \to Z \times_f X \to X
    2. AiBgZA \stackrel{i}{\to} B \stackrel{g}{\to} Z

    with universal morphism into the pullback being

    • AZ× fXA \to Z \times_f X
  • the other by

    1. AiBg^Z× fXXA \stackrel{i}{\to} B \stackrel{\hat g}{\to} Z \times_f X \to X
    2. AiBgZA \stackrel{i}{\to} B \stackrel{g}{\to} Z.

    with universal morphism into the pullback being

    • AiBg^Z× fXA \stackrel{i}{\to} B \stackrel{\hat g}{\to} Z \times_f X.

The commutativity of the diagrams that we have established so far shows that the first and second morphisms here equal each other, respectively. By the fact that the universal morphism into a pullback diagram is unique this implies the required identity of morphisms.

The other case is formally dual.

closure under (co-)products

Let {(A si sB s)KProj} sS\{(A_s \overset{i_s}{\to} B_s) \in K Proj\}_{s \in S} be a set of elements of KProjK Proj. Since colimits in the presheaf category 𝒞 Δ[1]\mathcal{C}^{\Delta[1]} are computed componentwise, their coproduct in this arrow category is the universal morphism out of the coproduct of objects sSA s\underset{s \in S}{\coprod} A_s induced via its universal property by the set of morphisms i si_s:

sSA s(i s) sSsSB s. \underset{s \in S}{\sqcup} A_s \overset{(i_s)_{s\in S}}{\longrightarrow} \underset{s \in S}{\sqcup} B_s \,.

Now let

sSA s X (i s) sS K f sSB s Y \array{ \underset{s \in S}{\sqcup} A_s &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{(i_s)_{s\in S}}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in K}} \\ \underset{s \in S}{\sqcup} B_s &\longrightarrow& Y }

be a commuting square. This is in particular a cocone under the coproduct of objects, hence by the universal property of the coproduct, this is equivalent to a set of commuting diagrams

{A s X KProj i s K f B s Y} sS. \left\{ \;\;\;\;\;\;\;\;\; \array{ A_s &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_s}}_{\mathllap{\in K Proj}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in K}} \\ B_s &\longrightarrow& Y } \;\;\;\; \right\}_{s\in S} \,.

By assumption, each of these has a lift s\ell_s. The collection of these lifts

{A s X Proj i s s K f B s Y} sS \left\{ \;\;\;\;\;\;\;\;\; \array{ A_s &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_s}}_{\mathllap{\in Proj}}\downarrow &{}^{\ell_s}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in K}} \\ B_s &\longrightarrow& Y } \;\;\;\; \right\}_{s\in S}

is now itself a compatible cocone, and so once more by the universal property of the coproduct, this is equivalent to a lift ( s) sS(\ell_s)_{s\in S} in the original square

sSA s X (i s) sS ( s) sS K f sSB s Y. \array{ \underset{s \in S}{\sqcup} A_s &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{(i_s)_{s\in S}}}\downarrow &{}^{(\ell_s)_{s\in S}}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in K}} \\ \underset{s \in S}{\sqcup} B_s &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.

This shows that the coproduct of the i si_s has the left lifting property against all fKf\in K and is hence in KProjK Proj. The other case is formally dual.

An immediate consequence of prop. is this:

Corollary

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a category with all small colimits, and let KMor(𝒞)K\subset Mor(\mathcal{C}) be a sub-class of its morphisms. Then every KK-injective morphism, def. , has the right lifting property, def. , against all KK-relative cell complexes, def. and their retracts, remark .

Remark

By a retract of a morphism XfYX \stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow} Y in some category 𝒞\mathcal{C} we mean a retract of ff as an object in the arrow category 𝒞 Δ[1]\mathcal{C}^{\Delta[1]}, hence a morphism AgBA \stackrel{g}{\longrightarrow} B such that in 𝒞 Δ[1]\mathcal{C}^{\Delta[1]} there is a factorization of the identity on gg through ff

id g:gfg. id_g \;\colon\; g \longrightarrow f \longrightarrow g \,.

This means equivalently that in 𝒞\mathcal{C} there is a commuting diagram of the form

id A: A X A g f g id B: B Y B. \array{ id_A \colon & A &\longrightarrow& X &\longrightarrow& A \\ & \downarrow^{\mathrlap{g}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{g}} \\ id_B \colon & B &\longrightarrow& Y &\longrightarrow& B } \,.
Lemma

In every category CC the class of isomorphisms is preserved under retracts in the sense of remark .

Proof

For

id A: A X A g f g id B: B Y B. \array{ id_A \colon & A &\longrightarrow& X &\longrightarrow& A \\ & \downarrow^{\mathrlap{g}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{g}} \\ id_B \colon & B &\longrightarrow& Y &\longrightarrow& B } \,.

a retract diagram and XfYX \overset{f}{\to} Y an isomorphism, the inverse to AgBA \overset{g}{\to} B is given by the composite

X A f 1 B Y . \array{ & & & X & \longrightarrow & A \\ & && \uparrow^{\mathrlap{f^{-1}}} && \\ & B & \longrightarrow& Y&& } \,.

More generally:

Proposition

Given a model category in the sense of def. , then its class of weak equivalences is closed under forming retracts (in the arrow category, see remark ).

(Joyal, prop. E.1.3)

Proof

Let

id: A X A f w f id: B Y B \array{ id \colon & A &\longrightarrow& X &\longrightarrow& A \\ & {}^{\mathllap{f}} \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{w}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ id \colon & B &\longrightarrow& Y &\longrightarrow& B }

be a commuting diagram in the given model category, with wWw \in W a weak equivalence. We need to show that then also fWf \in W.

First consider the case that fFibf \in Fib.

In this case, factor ww as a cofibration followed by an acyclic fibration. Since wWw \in W and by two-out-of-three (def. ) this is even a factorization through an acyclic cofibration followed by an acyclic fibration. Hence we obtain a commuting diagram of the following form:

id: A X AAAA A id WCof id id: A s X AAtAA A Fib f WFib Fib f id: B Y AAAA B, \array{ id \colon & A &\longrightarrow& X &\overset{\phantom{AAAA}}{\longrightarrow}& A \\ & {}^{\mathllap{id}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Cof}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{id}} \\ id \colon & A' &\overset{s}{\longrightarrow}& X' &\overset{\phantom{AA}t\phantom{AA}}{\longrightarrow}& A' \\ & {}^{\mathllap{f}}_{\mathllap{\in Fib}} \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Fib}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ id \colon & B &\longrightarrow& Y &\underset{\phantom{AAAA}}{\longrightarrow}& B } \,,

where ss is uniquely defined and where tt is any lift of the top middle vertical acyclic cofibration against ff. This now exhibits ff as a retract of an acyclic fibration. These are closed under retract by prop. .

Now consider the general case. Factor ff as an acyclic cofibration followed by a fibration and form the pushout in the top left square of the following diagram

id: A X AAAA A WCof (po) WCof WCof id: A X AAAA A Fib W Fib id: B Y AAAA B, \array{ id \colon & A &\longrightarrow& X &\overset{\phantom{AAAA}}{\longrightarrow}& A \\ & {}^{\mathllap{\in W \cap Cof}}\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Cof}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Cof}} \\ id \colon & A' &\overset{}{\longrightarrow}& X' &\overset{\phantom{AA}\phantom{AA}}{\longrightarrow}& A' \\ & {}^{\mathllap{\in Fib}} \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W }} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ id \colon & B &\longrightarrow& Y &\underset{\phantom{AAAA}}{\longrightarrow}& B } \,,

where the other three squares are induced by the universal property of the pushout, as is the identification of the middle horizontal composite as the identity on AA'. Since acyclic cofibrations are closed under forming pushouts by prop. , the top middle vertical morphism is now an acyclic fibration, and hence by assumption and by two-out-of-three so is the middle bottom vertical morphism.

Thus the previous case now gives that the bottom left vertical morphism is a weak equivalence, and hence the total left vertical composite is.

Lemma

(retract argument)

Consider a composite morphism

f:XiApY. f \;\colon\; X \stackrel{i}{\longrightarrow} A \stackrel{p}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.
  1. If ff has the left lifting property against pp, then ff is a retract of ii.

  2. If ff has the right lifting property against ii, then ff is a retract of pp.

Proof

We discuss the first statement, the second is formally dual.

Write the factorization of ff as a commuting square of the form

X i A f p Y = Y. \array{ X &\stackrel{i}{\longrightarrow}& A \\ {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ Y &= & Y } \,.

By the assumed lifting property of ff against pp there exists a diagonal filler gg making a commuting diagram of the form

X i A f g p Y = Y. \array{ X &\stackrel{i}{\longrightarrow}& A \\ {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow &{}^{\mathllap{g}}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ Y &= & Y } \,.

By rearranging this diagram a little, it is equivalent to

X = X f i id Y: Y g A p Y. \array{ & X &=& X \\ & {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow && {}^{\mathllap{i}}\downarrow \\ id_Y \colon & Y &\underset{g}{\longrightarrow}& A &\underset{p}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

Completing this to the right, this yields a diagram exhibiting the required retract according to remark :

id X: X = X = X f i f id Y: Y g A p Y. \array{ id_X \colon & X &=& X &=& X \\ & {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow && {}^{\mathllap{i}}\downarrow && {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow \\ id_Y \colon & Y &\underset{g}{\longrightarrow}& A &\underset{p}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

Small object argument

Given a set CMor(𝒞)C \subset Mor(\mathcal{C}) of morphisms in some category 𝒞\mathcal{C}, a natural question is how to factor any given morphism f:XYf\colon X \longrightarrow Y through a relative CC-cell complex, def. , followed by a CC-injective morphism, def.

f:XCcellX^CinjY. f \;\colon\; X \stackrel{\in C cell}{\longrightarrow} \hat X \stackrel{\in C inj}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.

A first approximation to such a factorization turns out to be given simply by forming X^=X 1\hat X = X_1 by attaching all possible CC-cells to XX. Namely let

(C/f){dom(c) X cC f cod(c) Y} (C/f) \coloneqq \left\{ \array{ dom(c) &\stackrel{}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{c\in C}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ cod(c) &\longrightarrow& Y } \right\}

be the set of all ways to find a CC-cell attachment in ff, and consider the pushout X^\hat X of the coproduct of morphisms in CC over all these:

c(C/f)dom(c) X c(C/f)c (po) c(C/f)cod(c) X 1. \array{ \underset{c\in(C/f)}{\coprod} dom(c) &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\underset{c\in(C/f)}{\coprod} c}}\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{}} \\ \underset{c\in(C/f)}{\coprod} cod(c) &\longrightarrow& X_1 } \,.

This gets already close to producing the intended factorization:

First of all the resulting map XX 1X \to X_1 is a CC-relative cell complex, by construction.

Second, by the fact that the coproduct is over all commuting squres to ff, the morphism ff itself makes a commuting diagram

c(C/f)dom(c) X c(C/f)c f c(C/f)cod(c) Y \array{ \underset{c\in(C/f)}{\coprod} dom(c) &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\underset{c\in(C/f)}{\coprod} c}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ \underset{c\in(C/f)}{\coprod} cod(c) &\longrightarrow& Y }

and hence the universal property of the colimit means that ff is indeed factored through that CC-cell complex X 1X_1; we may suggestively arrange that factorizing diagram like so:

c(C/f)dom(c) X id c(C/f)dom(c) X 1 c(C/f)c c(C/f)cod(c) Y. \array{ \underset{c\in(C/f)}{\coprod} dom(c) &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{id}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{}} \\ \underset{c\in(C/f)}{\coprod} dom(c) && X_1 \\ {}^{\mathllap{\underset{c\in(C/f)}{\coprod} c}}\downarrow &\nearrow& \downarrow \\ \underset{c\in(C/f)}{\coprod} cod(c) &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.

This shows that, finally, the colimiting co-cone map – the one that now appears diagonally – almost exhibits the desired right lifting of X 1YX_1 \to Y against the cCc\in C. The failure of that to hold on the nose is only the fact that a horizontal map in the middle of the above diagram is missing: the diagonal map obtained above lifts not all commuting diagrams of cCc\in C into ff, but only those where the top morphism dom(c)X 1dom(c) \to X_1 factors through XX 1X \to X_1.

The idea of the small object argument now is to fix this only remaining problem by iterating the construction: next factor X 1YX_1 \to Y in the same way into

X 1X 2Y X_1 \longrightarrow X_2 \longrightarrow Y

and so forth. Since relative CC-cell complexes are closed under composition, at stage nn the resulting XX nX \longrightarrow X_n is still a CC-cell complex, getting bigger and bigger. But accordingly, the failure of the accompanying X nYX_n \longrightarrow Y to be a CC-injective morphism becomes smaller and smaller, for it now lifts against all diagrams where dom(c)X ndom(c) \longrightarrow X_n factors through X n1X nX_{n-1}\longrightarrow X_n, which intuitively is less and less of a condition as the X n1X_{n-1} grow larger and larger.

The concept of small object is just what makes this intuition precise and finishes the small object argument. For the present purpose we just need the following simple version:

Definition

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} a category and CMor(𝒞)C \subset Mor(\mathcal{C}) a sub-set of its morphisms, say that these have small domains if there is an ordinal α\alpha (def. ) such that for every cCc\in C and for every CC-relative cell complex given by a transfinite composition (def. )

f:XX 1X 2X βX^ f \;\colon\; X \to X_1 \to X_2 \to \cdots \to X_\beta \to \cdots \longrightarrow \hat X

every morphism dom(c)X^dom(c)\longrightarrow \hat X factors through a stage X βX^X_\beta \to \hat X of order β<α\beta \lt \alpha:

X β dom(c) X^. \array{ && X_\beta \\ & \nearrow & \downarrow \\ dom(c) &\longrightarrow& \hat X } \,.

The above discussion proves the following:

Proposition

(small object argument)

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a locally small category with all small colimits. If a set CMor(𝒞)C\subset Mor(\mathcal{C}) of morphisms has all small domains in the sense of def. , then every morphism f:XYf\colon X\longrightarrow Y in 𝒞\mathcal{C} factors through a CC-relative cell complex, def. , followed by a CC-injective morphism, def.

f:XCcellX^CinjY. f \;\colon\; X \stackrel{\in C cell}{\longrightarrow} \hat X \stackrel{\in C inj}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.

(Quillen 67, II.3 lemma)

Homotopy

We discuss how the concept of homotopy is abstractly realized in model categories, def. .

Definition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category, def. , and X𝒞X \in \mathcal{C} an object.

  • A path space object Path(X)Path(X) for XX is a factorization of the diagonal Δ X:XX×X\Delta_X \;\colon\; X \to X \times X as
Δ X:XWiPath(X)Fib(p 0,p 1)X×X. \Delta_X \;\colon\; X \underoverset{\in W}{i}{\longrightarrow} Path(X) \underoverset{\in Fib}{(p_0,p_1)}{\longrightarrow} X \times X \,.

where XPath(X)X\to Path(X) is a weak equivalence and Path(X)X×XPath(X) \to X \times X is a fibration.

  • A cylinder object Cyl(X)Cyl(X) for XX is a factorization of the codiagonal (or “fold map”) X:XXX\nabla_X \;\colon\; X \sqcup X \to X as
X:XXCof(i 0,i 1)Cyl(X)WpX. \nabla_X \;\colon\; X \sqcup X \underoverset{\in Cof}{(i_0,i_1)}{\longrightarrow} Cyl(X) \underoverset{\in W}{p}{\longrightarrow} X \,.

where Cyl(X)XCyl(X) \to X is a weak equivalence. and XXCyl(X)X \sqcup X \to Cyl(X) is a cofibration.

Remark

For every object X𝒞X \in \mathcal{C} in a model category, a cylinder object and a path space object according to def. exist: the factorization axioms guarantee that there exists

  1. a factorization of the codiagonal as

    X:XXCofCyl(X)WFibX \nabla_X \;\colon\; X \sqcup X \overset{\in Cof}{\longrightarrow} Cyl(X) \overset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow} X
  2. a factorization of the diagonal as

    Δ X:XWCofPath(X)FibX×X. \Delta_X \;\colon\; X \overset{\in W \cap Cof}{\longrightarrow} Path(X) \overset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow} X \times X \,.

The cylinder and path space objects obtained this way are actually better than required by def. : in addition to Cyl(X)XCyl(X)\to X being just a weak equivalence, for these this is actually an acyclic fibration, and dually in addition to XPath(X)X\to Path(X) being a weak equivalence, for these it is actually an acyclic cofibration.

Some authors call cylinder/path-space objects with this extra property “very good” cylinder/path-space objects, respectively.

One may also consider dropping a condition in def. : what mainly matters is the weak equivalence, hence some authors take cylinder/path-space objects to be defined as in def. but without the condition that XXCyl(X)X \sqcup X\to Cyl(X) is a cofibration and without the condition that Path(X)X×XPath(X) \to X\times X is a fibration. Such authors would then refer to the concept in def. as “good” cylinder/path-space objects.

The terminology in def. follows the original (Quillen 67, I.1 def. 4). With the induced concept of left/right homotopy below in def. , this admits a quick derivation of the key facts in the following, as we spell out below.

Lemma

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category. If X𝒞X \in \mathcal{C} is cofibrant, then for every cylinder object Cyl(X)Cyl(X) of XX, def. , not only is (i 0,i 1):XXX(i_0,i_1) \colon X \sqcup X \to X a cofibration, but each

i 0,i 1:XCyl(X) i_0, i_1 \colon X \longrightarrow Cyl(X)

is an acyclic cofibration separately.

Dually, if X𝒞X \in \mathcal{C} is fibrant, then for every path space object Path(X)Path(X) of XX, def. , not only is (p 0,p 1):Path(X)X×X(p_0,p_1) \colon Path(X)\to X \times X a fibration, but each

p 0,p 1:Path(X)X p_0, p_1 \colon Path(X) \longrightarrow X

is an acyclic fibration separately.

Proof

We discuss the case of the path space object. The other case is formally dual.

First, that the component maps are weak equivalences follows generally: by definition they have a right inverse Path(X)XPath(X) \to X and so this follows by two-out-of-three (def. ).

But if XX is fibrant, then also the two projection maps out of the product X×XXX \times X \to X are fibrations, because they are both pullbacks of the fibration X*X \to \ast

X×X X (pb) X *. \array{ X\times X &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow \\ X &\longrightarrow& \ast } \,.

hence p i:Path(X)X×XXp_i \colon Path(X)\to X \times X \to X is the composite of two fibrations, and hence itself a fibration, by prop. .

Path space objects are very non-unique as objects up to isomorphism:

Example

If X𝒞X \in \mathcal{C} is a fibrant object in a model category, def. , and for Path 1(X)Path_1(X) and Path 2(X)Path_2(X) two path space objects for XX, def. , then the fiber product Path 1(X)× XPath 2(X)Path_1(X) \times_X Path_2(X) is another path space object for XX: the pullback square

X Δ X X×X Path 1(X)×XPath 2(X) Path 1(X)×Path 2(X) Fib (pb) Fib X×X×X (id,Δ X,id) X×X×X×X Fib (pr 1,pr 3) (p 1,p 4) X×X = X×X \array{ X &\overset{\Delta_X}{\longrightarrow}& X \times X \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ Path_1(X) \underset{X}{\times} Path_2(X) &\longrightarrow& Path_1(X)\times Path_2(X) \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in Fib}}\downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ X \times X \times X &\overset{(id,\Delta_X,id)}{\longrightarrow}& X \times X\times X \times X \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(pr_1,pr_3)}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(p_1, p_4)}} \\ X\times X &=& X \times X }

gives that the induced projection is again a fibration. Moreover, using lemma and two-out-of-three (def. ) gives that XPath 1(X)× XPath 2(X)X \to Path_1(X) \times_X Path_2(X) is a weak equivalence.

For the case of the canonical topological path space objects of def , with Path 1(X)=Path 2(X)=X I=X [0,1]Path_1(X) = Path_2(X) = X^I = X^{[0,1]} then this new path space object is X II=X [0,2]X^{I \vee I} = X^{[0,2]}, the mapping space out of the standard interval of length 2 instead of length 1.

Definition

Let f,g:XYf,g \colon X \longrightarrow Y be two parallel morphisms in a model category.

  • A left homotopy η:f Lg\eta \colon f \Rightarrow_L g is a morphism η:Cyl(X)Y\eta \colon Cyl(X) \longrightarrow Y from a cylinder object of XX, def. , such that it makes this diagram commute:
X Cyl(X) X f η g Y. \array{ X &\longrightarrow& Cyl(X) &\longleftarrow& X \\ & {}_{\mathllap{f}}\searrow &\downarrow^{\mathrlap{\eta}}& \swarrow_{\mathrlap{g}} \\ && Y } \,.
  • A right homotopy η:f Rg\eta \colon f \Rightarrow_R g is a morphism η:XPath(Y)\eta \colon X \to Path(Y) to some path space object of YY, def. , such that this diagram commutes:
X f η g Y Path(Y) Y. \array{ && X \\ & {}^{\mathllap{f}}\swarrow & \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\eta}} & \searrow^{\mathrlap{g}} \\ Y &\longleftarrow& Path(Y) &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.
Lemma

Let f,g:XYf,g \colon X \to Y be two parallel morphisms in a model category.

  1. Let XX be cofibrant. If there is a left homotopy f Lgf \Rightarrow_L g then there is also a right homotopy f Rgf \Rightarrow_R g (def. ) with respect to any chosen path space object.

  2. Let YY be fibrant. If there is a right homotopy f Rgf \Rightarrow_R g then there is also a left homotopy f Lgf \Rightarrow_L g with respect to any chosen cylinder object.

In particular if XX is cofibrant and YY is fibrant, then by going back and forth it follows that every left homotopy is exhibited by every cylinder object, and every right homotopy is exhibited by every path space object.

Proof

We discuss the first case, the second is formally dual. Let η:Cyl(X)Y\eta \colon Cyl(X) \longrightarrow Y be the given left homotopy. Lemma implies that we have a lift hh in the following commuting diagram

X if Path(Y) WCof i 0 h Fib p 0,p 1 Cyl(X) (fp,η) Y×Y, \array{ X &\overset{i \circ f}{\longrightarrow}& Path(Y) \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_0}}_{\mathllap{\in W \cap Cof}}\downarrow &{}^{\mathllap{h}}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_0,p_1}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ Cyl(X) &\underset{(f \circ p,\eta)}{\longrightarrow}& Y \times Y } \,,

where on the right we have the chosen path space object. Now the composite η˜hi 1\tilde \eta \coloneqq h \circ i_1 is a right homotopy as required:

Path(Y) h Fib p 0,p 1 X i 1 Cyl(X) (fp,η) Y×Y. \array{ && && Path(Y) \\ && &{}^{\mathllap{h}}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_0,p_1}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ X &\overset{i_1}{\longrightarrow}& Cyl(X) &\underset{(f \circ p,\eta)}{\longrightarrow}& Y \times Y } \,.
Proposition

For XX a cofibrant object in a model category and YY a fibrant object, the relations of left homotopy f Lgf \Rightarrow_L g and of right homotopy f Rgf \Rightarrow_R g (def. ) on the hom set Hom(X,Y)Hom(X,Y) coincide and are both equivalence relations.

Proof

That both relations coincide under the (co-)fibrancy assumption follows directly from lemma .

The symmetry and reflexivity of the relation is obvious.

That right homotopy (hence also left homotopy) with domain XX is a transitive relation follows from using example to compose path space objects.

The homotopy category

We discuss the construction that takes a model category, def. , and then universally forces all its weak equivalences into actual isomorphisms.

Definition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category, def. . Write Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}) for the category whose

and whose composition operation is given on representatives by composition in 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

This is, up to equivalence of categories, the homotopy category of the model category 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

Proposition

Def. is well defined, in that composition of morphisms between fibrant-cofibrant objects in 𝒞\mathcal{C} indeed passes to homotopy classes.

Proof

Fix any morphism XfYX \overset{f}{\to} Y between fibrant-cofibrant objects. Then for precomposition

()[f]:Hom Ho(𝒞)(Y,Z)Hom Ho(𝒞)(X,Z) (-) \circ [f] \;\colon\; Hom_{Ho(\mathcal{C})}(Y,Z) \to Hom_{Ho(\mathcal{C})}(X,Z)

to be well defined, we need that with (gh):YZ(g\sim h)\;\colon\; Y \to Z also (fgfh):XZ(f g \sim f h)\;\colon\; X \to Z. But by prop we may take the homotopy \sim to be exhibited by a right homotopy η:YPath(Z)\eta \colon Y \to Path(Z), for which case the statement is evident from this diagram:

Z g p 1 X f Y η Path(Z) h p 0 Z. \array{ && && Z \\ && & {}^{\mathllap{g}}\nearrow & \uparrow^{\mathrlap{p_1}} \\ X &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow} & Y &\overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& Path(Z) \\ && & {}_{\mathllap{h}}\searrow & \downarrow_{\mathrlap{p_0}} \\ && && Z } \,.

For postcomposition we may choose to exhibit homotopy by left homotopy and argue dually.

We now spell out that def. indeed satisfies the universal property that defines the localization of a category with weak equivalences at its weak equivalences.

Lemma

(Whitehead theorem in model categories)

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category. A weak equivalence between two objects which are both fibrant and cofibrant is a homotopy equivalence.

Proof

By the factorization axioms in the model category 𝒞\mathcal{C} and by two-out-of-three (def. ), every weak equivalence f:XYf\colon X \longrightarrow Y factors through an object ZZ as an acyclic cofibration followed by an acyclic fibration. In particular it follows that with XX and YY both fibrant and cofibrant, so is ZZ, and hence it is sufficient to prove that acyclic (co-)fibrations between such objects are homotopy equivalences.

So let f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y be an acyclic fibration between fibrant-cofibrant objects, the case of acyclic cofibrations is formally dual. Then in fact it has a genuine right inverse given by a lift f 1f^{-1} in the diagram

X cof f 1 FibW f Y = Y. \array{ \emptyset &\rightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in cof}}\downarrow &{}^{{f^{-1}}}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib \cap W}} \\ Y &=& Y } \,.

To see that f 1f^{-1} is also a left inverse up to left homotopy, let Cyl(X)Cyl(X) be any cylinder object on XX (def. ), hence a factorization of the codiagonal on XX as a cofibration followed by a an acyclic fibration

XXι XCyl(X)pX X \sqcup X \stackrel{\iota_X}{\longrightarrow} Cyl(X) \stackrel{p}{\longrightarrow} X

and consider the commuting square

XX (f 1f,id) X ι X Cof WFib f Cyl(X) fp Y, \array{ X \sqcup X &\stackrel{(f^{-1}\circ f, id)}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\iota_X}}{}_{\mathllap{\in Cof}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Fib}} \\ Cyl(X) &\underset{f\circ p}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,,

which commutes due to f 1f^{-1} being a genuine right inverse of ff. By construction, this commuting square now admits a lift η\eta, and that constitutes a left homotopy η:f 1f Lid\eta \colon f^{-1}\circ f \Rightarrow_L id.

Definition

Given a model category 𝒞\mathcal{C}, consider a choice for each object X𝒞X \in \mathcal{C} of

  1. a factorization Cofi XQXWFibp XX\emptyset \underoverset{\in Cof}{i_X}{\longrightarrow} Q X \underoverset{\in W \cap Fib}{p_X}{\longrightarrow} X of the initial morphism, such that when XX is already cofibrant then p X=id Xp_X = id_X;

  2. a factorization XWCofj XPXFibq X*X \underoverset{\in W \cap Cof}{j_X}{\longrightarrow} P X \underoverset{\in Fib}{q_X}{\longrightarrow} \ast of the terminal morphism, such that when XX is already fibrant then j X=id Xj_X = id_X.

Write then

γ P,Q:𝒞Ho(𝒞) \gamma_{P,Q} \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow Ho(\mathcal{C})

for the functor to the homotopy category, def. , which sends an object XX to the object PQXP Q X and sends a morphism f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y to the homotopy class of the result of first lifting in

QY i X Qf p Y QX fp X Y \array{ \emptyset &\longrightarrow& Q Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_X}}\downarrow &{}^{Q f}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_Y}} \\ Q X &\underset{f\circ p_X}{\longrightarrow}& Y }

and then lifting (here: extending) in

QX j QYQf PQY j QX PQf q QY PQX *. \array{ Q X &\overset{j_{Q Y} \circ Q f}{\longrightarrow}& P Q Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{j_{Q X}}}\downarrow &{}^{P Q f}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{q_{Q Y}}} \\ P Q X &\longrightarrow& \ast } \,.
Lemma

The construction in def. is indeed well defined.

Proof

First of all, the object PQXP Q X is indeed both fibrant and cofibrant (as well as related by a zig-zag of weak equivalences to XX):

Cof Cof QX WCof PQX Fib * W X. \array{ \emptyset \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in Cof}}\downarrow & \searrow^{\mathrlap{\in Cof}} \\ Q X &\underset{\in W \cap Cof}{\longrightarrow}& P Q X &\underset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow}& \ast \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in W}}\downarrow \\ X } \,.

Now to see that the image on morphisms is well defined. First observe that any two choices (Qf) i(Q f)_{i} of the first lift in the definition are left homotopic to each other, exhibited by lifting in

QXQX ((Qf) 1,(Qf) 2) QY Cof WFib p Y Cyl(QX) fp Xσ QX Y. \array{ Q X \sqcup Q X &\stackrel{((Q f)_1, (Q f)_2 )}{\longrightarrow}& Q Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in Cof}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_{Y}}}_{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Fib}} \\ Cyl(Q X) &\underset{f \circ p_{X} \circ \sigma_{Q X}}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

Hence also the composites j QY(Q f) ij_{Q Y}\circ (Q_f)_i are left homotopic to each other, and since their domain is cofibrant, then by lemma they are also right homotopic by a right homotopy κ\kappa. This implies finally, by lifting in

QX κ Path(PQY) WCof Fib PQX (P(Qf) 1,P(Qf) 2) PQY×PQY \array{ Q X &\overset{\kappa}{\longrightarrow}& Path(P Q Y) \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in W \cap Cof}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ P Q X &\underset{(P (Q f)_1, P (Q f)_2)}{\longrightarrow}& P Q Y \times P Q Y }

that also P(Qf) 1P (Q f)_1 and P(Qf) 2P (Q f)_2 are right homotopic, hence that indeed PQfP Q f represents a well-defined homotopy class.

Finally to see that the assignment is indeed functorial, observe that the commutativity of the lifting diagrams for QfQ f and PQfP Q f imply that also the following diagram commutes

X p X QX j QX PQX f Qf PQf Y p y QY j QY PQY. \array{ X &\overset{p_X}{\longleftarrow}& Q X &\overset{j_{Q X}}{\longrightarrow}& P Q X \\ {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{Q f}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{P Q f}} \\ Y &\underset{p_y}{\longleftarrow}& Q Y &\underset{j_{Q Y}}{\longrightarrow}& P Q Y } \,.

Now from the pasting composite

X p X QX j QX PQX f Qf PQf Y p Y QY j QY PQY g Qg PQg Z p Z QZ j QZ PQZ \array{ X &\overset{p_X}{\longleftarrow}& Q X &\overset{j_{Q X}}{\longrightarrow}& P Q X \\ {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{Q f}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{P Q f}} \\ Y &\underset{p_Y}{\longleftarrow}& Q Y &\underset{j_{Q Y}}{\longrightarrow}& P Q Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{g}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{Q g}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{P Q g}} \\ Z &\underset{p_Z}{\longleftarrow}& Q Z &\underset{j_{Q Z}}{\longrightarrow}& P Q Z }

one sees that (PQg)(PQf)(P Q g)\circ (P Q f) is a lift of gfg \circ f and hence the same argument as above gives that it is homotopic to the chosen PQ(gf)P Q(g \circ f).

For the following, recall the concept of natural isomorphism between functors: for F,G:𝒞𝒟F, G \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow \mathcal{D} two functors, then a natural transformation η:FG\eta \colon F \Rightarrow G is for each object cObj(𝒞)c \in Obj(\mathcal{C}) a morphism η c:F(c)G(c)\eta_c \colon F(c) \longrightarrow G(c) in 𝒟\mathcal{D}, such that for each morphism f:c 1c 2f \colon c_1 \to c_2 in 𝒞\mathcal{C} the following is a commuting square:

F(c 1) η c 1 G(c 1) F(f) G(f) F(c 2) η c 2 G(c 2). \array{ F(c_1) &\overset{\eta_{c_1}}{\longrightarrow}& G(c_1) \\ {}^{\mathllap{F(f)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{G(f)}} \\ F(c_2) &\underset{\eta_{c_2}}{\longrightarrow}& G(c_2) } \,.

Such η\eta is called a natural isomorphism if its η c\eta_c are isomorphisms for all objects cc.

Definition

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} a category with weak equivalences, its localization at the weak equivalences is, if it exists,

  1. a category denoted 𝒞[W 1]\mathcal{C}[W^{-1}]

  2. a functor

    γ:𝒞𝒞[W 1] \gamma \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow \mathcal{C}[W^{-1}]

such that

  1. γ\gamma sends weak equivalences to isomorphisms;

  2. γ\gamma is universal with this property, in that:

    for F:𝒞DF \colon \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow D any functor out of 𝒞\mathcal{C} into any category DD, such that FF takes weak equivalences to isomorphisms, it factors through γ\gamma up to a natural isomorphism ρ\rho

    𝒞 F D γ ρ F˜ Ho(𝒞) \array{ \mathcal{C} && \overset{F}{\longrightarrow} && D \\ & {}_{\mathllap{\gamma}}\searrow &\Downarrow^{\rho}& \nearrow_{\mathrlap{\tilde F}} \\ && Ho(\mathcal{C}) }

    and this factorization is unique up to unique isomorphism, in that for (F˜ 1,ρ 1)(\tilde F_1, \rho_1) and (F˜ 2,ρ 2)(\tilde F_2, \rho_2) two such factorizations, then there is a unique natural isomorphism κ:F˜ 1F˜ 2\kappa \colon \tilde F_1 \Rightarrow \tilde F_2 making the evident diagram of natural isomorphisms commute.

Theorem

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} a model category, the functor γ P,Q\gamma_{P,Q} in def. (for any choice of PP and QQ) exhibits Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}) as indeed being the localization of the underlying category with weak equivalences at its weak equivalences, in the sense of def. :

𝒞 = 𝒞 γ P,Q γ Ho(𝒞) 𝒞[W 1]. \array{ \mathcal{C} &=& \mathcal{C} \\ {}^{\mathllap{\gamma_{P,Q}}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma}} \\ Ho(\mathcal{C}) &\simeq& \mathcal{C}[W^{-1}] } \,.

(Quillen 67, I.1 theorem 1)

Proof

First, to see that that γ P,Q\gamma_{P,Q} indeed takes weak equivalences to isomorphisms: By two-out-of-three (def. ) applied to the commuting diagrams shown in the proof of lemma , the morphism PQfP Q f is a weak equivalence if ff is:

X p X QX j QX PQX f Qf PQf (Y p y QY j QY PQY \array{ X &\underoverset{\simeq}{p_X}{\longleftarrow}& Q X &\underoverset{\simeq}{j_{Q X}}{\longrightarrow}& P Q X \\ {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{Q f}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{P Q f}} \\( Y &\underoverset{p_y}{\simeq}{\longleftarrow}& Q Y &\underoverset{j_{Q Y}}{\simeq}{\longrightarrow}& P Q Y }

With this the “Whitehead theorem for model categories”, lemma , implies that PQfP Q f represents an isomorphism in Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}).

Now let F:𝒞DF \colon \mathcal{C}\longrightarrow D be any functor that sends weak equivalences to isomorphisms. We need to show that it factors as

𝒞 F D γ ρ F˜ Ho(𝒞) \array{ \mathcal{C} && \overset{F}{\longrightarrow} && D \\ & {}_{\mathllap{\gamma}}\searrow &\Downarrow^{\rho}& \nearrow_{\mathrlap{\tilde F}} \\ && Ho(\mathcal{C}) }

uniquely up to unique natural isomorphism. Now by construction of PP and QQ in def. , γ P,Q\gamma_{P,Q} is the identity on the full subcategory of fibrant-cofibrant objects. It follows that if F˜\tilde F exists at all, it must satisfy for all XfYX \stackrel{f}{\to} Y with XX and YY both fibrant and cofibrant that

F˜([f])F(f), \tilde F([f]) \simeq F(f) \,,

(hence in particular F˜(γ P,Q(f))F(PQf)\tilde F(\gamma_{P,Q}(f)) \simeq F(P Q f)).

But by def. that already fixes F˜\tilde F on all of Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}), up to unique natural isomorphism. Hence it only remains to check that with this definition of F˜\tilde F there exists any natural isomorphism ρ\rho filling the diagram above.

To that end, apply FF to the above commuting diagram to obtain

F(X) isoF(p X) F(QX) isoF(j QX) F(PQX) F(f) F(Qf) F(PQf) F(Y) F(p y)iso F(QY) F(j QY)iso F(PQY). \array{ F(X) &\underoverset{iso}{F(p_X)}{\longleftarrow}& F(Q X) &\underoverset{iso}{F(j_{Q X})}{\longrightarrow}& F(P Q X) \\ {}^{\mathllap{F(f)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{F(Q f)}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{F(P Q f)}} \\ F(Y) &\underoverset{F(p_y)}{iso}{\longleftarrow}& F(Q Y) &\underoverset{F(j_{Q Y})}{iso}{\longrightarrow}& F(P Q Y) } \,.

Here now all horizontal morphisms are isomorphisms, by assumption on FF. It follows that defining ρ XF(j QX)F(p X) 1\rho_X \coloneqq F(j_{Q X}) \circ F(p_X)^{-1} makes the required natural isomorphism:

ρ X: F(X) isoF(p X) 1 F(QX) isoF(j QX) F(PQX) = F˜(γ P,Q(X)) F(f) F(PQf) F˜(γ P,Q(f)) ρ Y: F(Y) F(p y) 1iso F(QY) F(j QY)iso F(PQY) = F˜(γ P,Q(X)). \array{ \rho_X \colon & F(X) &\underoverset{iso}{F(p_X)^{-1}}{\longrightarrow}& F(Q X) &\underoverset{iso}{F(j_{Q X})}{\longrightarrow}& F(P Q X) &=& \tilde F(\gamma_{P,Q}(X)) \\ & {}^{\mathllap{F(f)}}\downarrow && && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{F(P Q f)}} && \downarrow^{\tilde F(\gamma_{P,Q}(f))} \\ \rho_Y\colon& F(Y) &\underoverset{F(p_y)^{-1}}{iso}{\longrightarrow}& F(Q Y) &\underoverset{F(j_{Q Y})}{iso}{\longrightarrow}& F(P Q Y) &=& \tilde F(\gamma_{P,Q}(X)) } \,.
Remark

Due to theorem we may suppress the choices of cofibrant QQ and fibrant replacement PP in def. and just speak of the localization functor

γ:𝒞Ho(𝒞) \gamma \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow Ho(\mathcal{C})

up to natural isomorphism.

In general, the localization 𝒞[W 1]\mathcal{C}[W^{-1}] of a category with weak equivalences (𝒞,W)(\mathcal{C},W) (def. ) may invert more morphisms than just those in WW. However, if the category admits the structure of a model category (𝒞,W,Cof,Fib)(\mathcal{C},W,Cof,Fib), then its localization precisely only inverts the weak equivalences:

Proposition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category (def. ) and let γ:𝒞Ho(𝒞)\gamma \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow Ho(\mathcal{C}) be its localization functor (def. , theorem ). Then a morphism ff in 𝒞\mathcal{C} is a weak equivalence precisely if γ(f)\gamma(f) is an isomorphism in Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}).

(e.g. Goerss-Jardine 96, II, prop 1.14)

While the construction of the homotopy category in def. combines the restriction to good (fibrant/cofibrant) objects with the passage to homotopy classes of morphisms, it is often useful to consider intermediate stages:

Definition

Given a model category 𝒞\mathcal{C}, write

𝒞 fc 𝒞 c 𝒞 f 𝒞 \array{ && \mathcal{C}_{f c} \\ & \swarrow && \searrow \\ \mathcal{C}_c && && \mathcal{C}_f \\ & \searrow && \swarrow \\ && \mathcal{C} }

for the system of full subcategory inclusions of:

  1. the category of fibrant objects 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f

  2. the category of cofibrant objects 𝒞 c\mathcal{C}_c,

  3. the category of fibrant-cofibrant objects 𝒞 fc\mathcal{C}_{fc},

all regarded a categories with weak equivalences (def. ), via the weak equivalences inherited from 𝒞\mathcal{C}, which we write (𝒞 f,W f)(\mathcal{C}_f, W_f), (𝒞 c,W c)(\mathcal{C}_c, W_c) and (𝒞 fc,W fc)(\mathcal{C}_{f c}, W_{f c}).

Remark

Of course the subcategories in def. inherit more structure than just that of categories with weak equivalences from 𝒞\mathcal{C}. 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f and 𝒞 c\mathcal{C}_c each inherit “half” of the factorization axioms. One says that 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f has the structure of a “fibration category” called a “Brown-category of fibrant objects”, while 𝒞 c\mathcal{C}_c has the structure of a “cofibration category”.

We discuss properties of these categories of (co-)fibrant objects below in Homotopy fiber sequences.

The proof of theorem immediately implies the following:

Corollary

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} a model category, the restriction of the localization functor γ:𝒞Ho(𝒞)\gamma\;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow Ho(\mathcal{C}) from def. (using remark ) to any of the sub-categories with weak equivalences of def.

𝒞 fc 𝒞 c 𝒞 f 𝒞 γ Ho(𝒞) \array{ && \mathcal{C}_{f c} \\ & \swarrow && \searrow \\ \mathcal{C}_c && && \mathcal{C}_f \\ & \searrow && \swarrow \\ && \mathcal{C} \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma}} \\ && Ho(\mathcal{C}) }

exhibits Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}) equivalently as the localization also of these subcategories with weak equivalences, at their weak equivalences. In particular there are equivalences of categories

Ho(𝒞)𝒞[W 1]𝒞 f[W f 1]𝒞 c[W c 1]𝒞 fc[W fc 1]. Ho(\mathcal{C}) \simeq \mathcal{C}[W^{-1}] \simeq \mathcal{C}_f[W_f^{-1}] \simeq \mathcal{C}_c[W_c^{-1}] \simeq \mathcal{C}_{f c}[W_{f c}^{-1}] \,.

The following says that for computing the hom-sets in the homotopy category, even a mixed variant of the above will do; it is sufficient that the domain is cofibrant and the codomain is fibrant:

Lemma

For X,Y𝒞X, Y \in \mathcal{C} with XX cofibrant and YY fibrant, and for P,QP, Q fibrant/cofibrant replacement functors as in def. , the morphism

Hom Ho(𝒞)(PX,QY)=Hom 𝒞(PX,QY)/ Hom 𝒞(j X,p Y)Hom 𝒞(X,Y)/ Hom_{Ho(\mathcal{C})}(P X,Q Y) = Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(P X, Q Y)/_{\sim} \overset{Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(j_X, p_Y)}{\longrightarrow} Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(X,Y)/_{\sim}

(on homotopy classes of morphisms, well defined by prop. ) is a natural bijection.

(Quillen 67, I.1 corollary 1)

Proof

We may factor the morphism in question as the composite

Hom 𝒞(PX,QY)/ Hom 𝒞(id PX,p Y)/ Hom 𝒞(PX,Y)/ Hom 𝒞(j X,id Y)/ Hom 𝒞(X,Y)/ . Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(P X, Q Y)/_{\sim} \overset{Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(id_{P X}, p_Y)/_\sim }{\longrightarrow} Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(P X, Y)/_{\sim} \overset{Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(j_X, id_Y)/_\sim}{\longrightarrow} Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(X,Y)/_{\sim} \,.

This shows that it is sufficient to see that for XX cofibrant and YY fibrant, then

Hom 𝒞(id X,p Y)/ :Hom 𝒞(X,QY)/ Hom 𝒞(X,Y)/ Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(id_X, p_Y)/_\sim \;\colon\; Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(X, Q Y)/_\sim \to Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(X,Y)/_\sim

is an isomorphism, and dually that

Hom 𝒞(j X,id Y)/ :Hom 𝒞(PX,Y)/ Hom 𝒞(X,Y)/ Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(j_X, id_Y)/_\sim \;\colon\; Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(P X, Y)/_\sim \to Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(X,Y)/_\sim

is an isomorphism. We discuss this for the former; the second is formally dual:

First, that Hom 𝒞(id X,p Y)Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(id_X, p_Y) is surjective is the lifting property in

QY Cof WFib p Y X f Y, \array{ \emptyset &\longrightarrow& Q Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in Cof}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_Y}}_{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Fib}} \\ X &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,,

which says that any morphism f:XYf \colon X \to Y comes from a morphism f^:XQY\hat f \colon X \to Q Y under postcomposition with QYp YYQ Y \overset{p_Y}{\to} Y.

Second, that Hom 𝒞(id X,p Y)Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(id_X, p_Y) is injective is the lifting property in

XX (f,g) QY Cof WFib p Y Cyl(X) η Y, \array{ X \sqcup X &\overset{(f,g)}{\longrightarrow}& Q Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in Cof}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_Y}}_{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Fib}} \\ Cyl(X) &\underset{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,,

which says that if two morphisms f,g:XQYf, g \colon X \to Q Y become homotopic after postcomposition with p Y:QXYp_Y \colon Q X \to Y, then they were already homotopic before.

We record the following fact which will be used in part 1.1 (here):

Lemma

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category (def. ). Then every commuting square in its homotopy category Ho(C)Ho(C) (def. ) is, up to isomorphism of squares, in the image of the localization functor 𝒞Ho(𝒞)\mathcal{C} \longrightarrow Ho(\mathcal{C}) of a commuting square in 𝒞\mathcal{C} (i.e.: not just commuting up to homotopy).

Proof

Let

A f B a b A f BHo(𝒞) \array{ A &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& B \\ {}^{\mathllap{a}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{b}} \\ A' &\underset{f'}{\longrightarrow}& B' } \;\;\;\;\; \in Ho(\mathcal{C})

be a commuting square in the homotopy category. Writing the same symbols for fibrant-cofibrant objects in 𝒞\mathcal{C} and for morphisms in 𝒞\mathcal{C} representing these, then this means that in 𝒞\mathcal{C} there is a left homotopy of the form

A f B i 1 b Cyl(A) η B i 0 f A a A. \array{ A &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& B \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_1}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{b}} \\ Cyl(A) &\underset{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& B' \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_0}}\uparrow && \uparrow^{\mathrlap{f'}} \\ A &\underset{a}{\longrightarrow}& A' } \,.

Consider the factorization of the top square here through the mapping cylinder of ff

A f B i 1 (po) W Cyl(A) Cyl(f) i 0 η A B a f A \array{ A &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& B \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_1}}\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} \\ Cyl(A) &\underset{}{\longrightarrow}& Cyl(f) \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_0}}\uparrow &{}_{\mathllap{\eta}}\searrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{}} \\ A && B' \\ & {}_{\mathllap{a}}\searrow & \uparrow_{\mathrlap{f'}} \\ && A' }

This exhibits the composite Ai 0Cyl(A)Cyl(f)A \overset{i_0}{\to} Cyl(A) \to Cyl(f) as an alternative representative of ff in Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}), and Cyl(f)BCyl(f) \to B' as an alternative representative for bb, and the commuting square

A Cyl(f) a A f B \array{ A &\overset{}{\longrightarrow}& Cyl(f) \\ {}^{\mathllap{a}}\downarrow && \downarrow \\ A' &\underset{f'}{\longrightarrow}& B' }

as an alternative representative of the given commuting square in Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}).

Derived functors

Definition

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} and 𝒟\mathcal{D} two categories with weak equivalences, def. , then a functor F:𝒞𝒟F \colon \mathcal{C}\longrightarrow \mathcal{D} is called a homotopical functor if it sends weak equivalences to weak equivalences.

Definition

Given a homotopical functor F:𝒞𝒟F \colon \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow \mathcal{D} (def. ) between categories with weak equivalences whose homotopy categories Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}) and Ho(𝒟)Ho(\mathcal{D}) exist (def. ), then its (“total”) derived functor is the functor Ho(F)Ho(F) between these homotopy categories which is induced uniquely, up to unique isomorphism, by their universal property (def. ):

𝒞 F 𝒟 γ 𝒞 γ 𝒟 Ho(𝒞) Ho(F) Ho(𝒟). \array{ \mathcal{C} &\overset{F}{\longrightarrow}& \mathcal{D} \\ {}^{\mathllap{\gamma_{\mathcal{C}}}}\downarrow &\swArrow_{\simeq}& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma_{\mathcal{D}}}} \\ Ho(\mathcal{C}) &\underset{\exists \; Ho(F)}{\longrightarrow}& Ho(\mathcal{D}) } \,.
Remark

While many functors of interest between model categories are not homotopical in the sense of def. , many become homotopical after restriction to the full subcategories 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f of fibrant objects or 𝒞 c\mathcal{C}_c of cofibrant objects, def. . By corollary this is just as good for the purpose of homotopy theory.

Therefore one considers the following generalization of def. :

Definition

(left and right derived functors)

Consider a functor F:𝒞𝒟F \colon \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow \mathcal{D} out of a model category 𝒞\mathcal{C} (def. ) into a category with weak equivalences 𝒟\mathcal{D} (def. ).

  1. If the restriction of FF to the full subcategory 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f of fibrant object becomes a homotopical functor (def. ), then the derived functor of that restriction, according to def. , is called the right derived functor of FF and denoted by F\mathbb{R}F:

    𝒞 f 𝒞 F 𝒟 γ 𝒞 f γ 𝒟 F: 𝒞 f[W 1] Ho(𝒞) Ho(F) Ho(𝒟), \array{ & \mathcal{C}_f &\hookrightarrow& \mathcal{C} &\overset{F}{\longrightarrow}& \mathcal{D} \\ & {}^{\mathllap{\gamma}_{\mathcal{C}_f}} \downarrow && \swArrow_{\simeq} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma_{\mathcal{D}}}} \\ \mathbb{R} F \colon & \mathcal{C}_f[W^{-1}] &\simeq& Ho(\mathcal{C}) &\underset{Ho(F)}{\longrightarrow}& Ho(\mathcal{D}) } \,,

    where we use corollary .

  2. If the restriction of FF to the full subcategory 𝒞 c\mathcal{C}_c of cofibrant object becomes a homotopical functor (def. ), then the derived functor of that restriction, according to def. , is called the left derived functor of FF and denoted by 𝕃F\mathbb{L}F:

    𝒞 c 𝒞 F 𝒟 γ 𝒞 f γ 𝒟 𝕃F: 𝒞 c[W 1] Ho(𝒞) Ho(F) Ho(𝒟), \array{ & \mathcal{C}_c &\hookrightarrow& \mathcal{C} &\overset{F}{\longrightarrow}& \mathcal{D} \\ & {}^{\mathllap{\gamma}_{\mathcal{C}_f}}\downarrow && \swArrow_{\simeq} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma_{\mathcal{D}}}} \\ \mathbb{L} F \colon & \mathcal{C}_c[W^{-1}] &\simeq& Ho(\mathcal{C}) &\underset{Ho(F)}{\longrightarrow}& Ho(\mathcal{D}) } \,,

    where again we use corollary .

The key fact that makes def. practically relevant is the following:

Proposition

(Ken Brown's lemma)

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category with full subcategories 𝒞 f,𝒞 c\mathcal{C}_f, \mathcal{C}_c of fibrant objects and of cofibrant objects respectively (def. ). Let 𝒟\mathcal{D} be a category with weak equivalences.

  1. A functor out of the category of fibrant objects

    F:𝒞 f𝒟 F \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}_f \longrightarrow \mathcal{D}

    is a homotopical functor, def. , already if it sends acylic fibrations to weak equivalences.

  2. A functor out of the category of cofibrant objects

    F:𝒞 c𝒟 F \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}_c \longrightarrow \mathcal{D}

    is a homotopical functor, def. , already if it sends acylic cofibrations to weak equivalences.

The following proof refers to the factorization lemma, whose full statement and proof we postpone to further below (lemma ).

Proof

We discuss the case of a functor on a category of fibrant objects 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f, def. . The other case is formally dual.

Let f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y be a weak equivalence in 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f. Choose a path space object Path(X)Path(X) (def. ) and consider the diagram

Path(f) WFib X W p 1 *f (pb) W f Path(Y) WFibp 1 Y WFib p 0 Y, \array{ Path(f) &\underset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{p_1^\ast f}}_{\mathllap{\in W}}\downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in W}} \\ Path(Y) &\overset{p_1}{\underset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow}}& Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{p_0}}_{\mathllap{\in W \cap Fib}}\downarrow \\ Y } \,,

where the square is a pullback and Path(f)Path(f) on the top left is our notation for the universal cone object. (Below we discuss this in more detail, it is the mapping cocone of ff, def. ).

Here:

  1. p ip_i are both acyclic fibrations, by lemma ;

  2. Path(f)XPath(f) \to X is an acyclic fibration because it is the pullback of p 1p_1.

  3. p 1 *fp_1^\ast f is a weak equivalence, because the factorization lemma states that the composite vertical morphism factors ff through a weak equivalence, hence if ff is a weak equivalence, then p 1 *fp_1^\ast f is by two-out-of-three (def. ).

Now apply the functor FF to this diagram and use the assumption that it sends acyclic fibrations to weak equivalences to obtain

F(Path(f)) W F(X) F(p 1 *f) F(f) F(Path(Y)) WF(p 1) F(Y) W F(p 0) Y. \array{ F(Path(f)) &\underset{\in W }{\longrightarrow}& F(X) \\ {}^{\mathllap{F(p_1^\ast f)}}_{\mathllap{}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{F(f)}} \\ F(Path(Y)) &\overset{F(p_1)}{\underset{\in W }{\longrightarrow}}& F(Y) \\ {}^{\mathllap{F(p_0)}}_{\mathllap{\in W}}\downarrow \\ Y } \,.

But the factorization lemma , in addition says that the vertical composite p 0p 1 *fp_0 \circ p_1^\ast f is a fibration, hence an acyclic fibration by the above. Therefore also F(p 0p 1 *f)F(p_0 \circ p_1^\ast f) is a weak equivalence. Now the claim that also F(f)F(f) is a weak equivalence follows with applying two-out-of-three (def. ) twice.

Corollary

Let 𝒞,𝒟\mathcal{C}, \mathcal{D} be model categories and consider F:𝒞𝒟F \colon \mathcal{C}\longrightarrow \mathcal{D} a functor. Then:

  1. If FF preserves cofibrant objects and acyclic cofibrations between these, then its left derived functor (def. ) 𝕃F\mathbb{L}F exists, fitting into a diagram

    𝒞 c F 𝒟 c γ 𝒞 γ 𝒟 Ho(𝒞) 𝕃F Ho(𝒟) \array{ \mathcal{C}_{c} &\overset{F}{\longrightarrow}& \mathcal{D}_{c} \\ {}^{\mathllap{\gamma_{\mathcal{C}}}}\downarrow &\swArrow_{\simeq}& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma_{\mathcal{D}}}} \\ Ho(\mathcal{C}) &\overset{\mathbb{L}F}{\longrightarrow}& Ho(\mathcal{D}) }
  2. If FF preserves fibrant objects and acyclic fibrants between these, then its right derived functor (def. ) F\mathbb{R}F exists, fitting into a diagram

    𝒞 f F 𝒟 f γ 𝒞 γ 𝒟 Ho(𝒞) F Ho(𝒟). \array{ \mathcal{C}_{f} &\overset{F}{\longrightarrow}& \mathcal{D}_{f} \\ {}^{\mathllap{\gamma_{\mathcal{C}}}}\downarrow &\swArrow_{\simeq}& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma_{\mathcal{D}}}} \\ Ho(\mathcal{C}) &\underset{\mathbb{R}F}{\longrightarrow}& Ho(\mathcal{D}) } \,.
Proposition

Let F:𝒞𝒟F \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow \mathcal{D} be a functor between two model categories (def. ).

  1. If FF preserves fibrant objects and weak equivalences between fibrant objects, then the total right derived functor F(γ 𝒟F)\mathbb{R}F \coloneqq \mathbb{R}(\gamma_{\mathcal{D}}\circ F) (def. ) in

    𝒞 f F 𝒟 γ 𝒞 f γ 𝒟 Ho(𝒞) F Ho(𝒟) \array{ \mathcal{C}_f &\overset{F}{\longrightarrow}& \mathcal{D} \\ {}^{\mathllap{\gamma_{\mathcal{C}_f}}}\downarrow &\swArrow_{\simeq}& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma_{\mathcal{D}}}} \\ Ho(\mathcal{C}) &\underset{\mathbb{R}F}{\longrightarrow}& Ho(\mathcal{D}) }

    is given, up to isomorphism, on any object X𝒞γ 𝒞Ho(𝒞) X\in \mathcal{C} \overset{\gamma_{\mathcal{C}}}{\longrightarrow} Ho(\mathcal{C}) by applying FF to a fibrant replacement PXP X of XX and then forming a cofibrant replacement Q(F(PX))Q(F(P X)) of the result:

F(X)Q(F(PX)). \mathbb{R}F(X) \simeq Q(F(P X)) \,.
  1. If FF preserves cofibrant objects and weak equivalences between cofibrant objects, then the total left derived functor 𝕃F𝕃(γ 𝒟F)\mathbb{L}F \coloneqq \mathbb{L}(\gamma_{\mathcal{D}}\circ F) (def. ) in

    𝒞 c F 𝒟 γ 𝒞 c γ 𝒟 Ho(𝒞) 𝕃F Ho(𝒟) \array{ \mathcal{C}_c &\overset{F}{\longrightarrow}& \mathcal{D} \\ {}^{\mathllap{\gamma_{\mathcal{C}_c}}}\downarrow &\swArrow_{\simeq}& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma_{\mathcal{D}}}} \\ Ho(\mathcal{C}) &\underset{\mathbb{L}F}{\longrightarrow}& Ho(\mathcal{D}) }

    is given, up to isomorphism, on any object X𝒞γ 𝒞Ho(𝒞) X\in \mathcal{C} \overset{\gamma_{\mathcal{C}}}{\longrightarrow} Ho(\mathcal{C}) by appying FF to a cofibrant replacement QXQ X of XX and then forming a fibrant replacement P(F(QX))P(F(Q X)) of the result:

𝕃F(X)P(F(QX)). \mathbb{L}F(X) \simeq P(F(Q X)) \,.
Proof

We discuss the first case, the second is formally dual. By the proof of theorem we have

F(X) γ 𝒟(F(γ 𝒞)) γ 𝒟F(Q(P(X))). \begin{aligned} \mathbb{R}F(X) & \simeq \gamma_{\mathcal{D}}(F(\gamma_{\mathcal{C}})) \\ & \simeq \gamma_{\mathcal{D}}F(Q(P(X)) ) \end{aligned} \,.

But since FF is a homotopical functor on fibrant objects, the cofibrant replacement morphism F(Q(P(X)))F(P(X))F(Q(P(X)))\to F(P(X)) is a weak equivalence in 𝒟\mathcal{D}, hence becomes an isomorphism under γ 𝒟\gamma_{\mathcal{D}}. Therefore

F(X)γ 𝒟(F(P(X))). \mathbb{R}F(X) \simeq \gamma_{\mathcal{D}}(F(P(X))) \,.

Now since FF is assumed to preserve fibrant objects, F(P(X))F(P(X)) is fibrant in 𝒟\mathcal{D}, and hence γ 𝒟\gamma_{\mathcal{D}} acts on it (only) by cofibrant replacement.

Quillen adjunctions

In practice it turns out to be useful to arrange for the assumptions in corollary to be satisfied by pairs of adjoint functors. Recall that this is a pair of functors LL and RR going back and forth between two categories

𝒞RL𝒟 \mathcal{C} \underoverset {\underset{R}{\longrightarrow}} {\overset{L}{\longleftarrow}} {} \mathcal{D}

such that there is a natural bijection between hom-sets with LL on the left and those with RR on the right:

ϕ d,c:Hom 𝒞(L(d),c)Hom 𝒟(d,R(c)) \phi_{d,c} \;\colon\; Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(L(d),c) \underoverset{\simeq}{}{\longrightarrow} Hom_{\mathcal{D}}(d, R(c))

for all objects d𝒟d\in \mathcal{D} and c𝒞c \in \mathcal{C}. This being natural means that ϕ:Hom 𝒟(L(),)Hom 𝒞(,R())\phi \colon Hom_{\mathcal{D}}(L(-),-) \Rightarrow Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(-, R(-)) is a natural transformation, hence that for all morphisms g:d 2d 1g \colon d_2 \to d_1 and f:c 1c 2f \colon c_1 \to c_2 the following is a commuting square:

Hom 𝒞(L(d 1),c 1) ϕ d 1,c 1 Hom 𝒟(d 1,R(c 1)) L(f)()g g()R(g) Hom 𝒞(L(d 2),c 2) ϕ d 2,c 2 Hom 𝒟(d 2,R(c 2)). \array{ Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(L(d_1), c_1) & \underoverset{\simeq}{\phi_{d_1,c_1}}{\longrightarrow} & Hom_{\mathcal{D}}(d_1, R(c_1)) \\ {}^{\mathllap{L(f) \circ (-)\circ g}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{g\circ (-)\circ R(g)}} \\ Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(L(d_2), c_2) & \underoverset{\phi_{d_2, c_2}}{\simeq}{\longrightarrow} & Hom_{\mathcal{D}}(d_2, R(c_2)) } \,.

We write (LR)(L \dashv R) to indicate an adjunction and call LL the left adjoint and RR the right adjoint of the adjoint pair.

The archetypical example of a pair of adjoint functors is that consisting of forming Cartesian products Y×()Y \times (-) and forming mapping spaces () Y(-)^Y, as in the category of compactly generated topological spaces of def. .

If f:L(d)cf \colon L(d) \to c is any morphism, then the image ϕ d,c(f):dR(c)\phi_{d,c}(f) \colon d \to R(c) is called its adjunct, and conversely. The fact that adjuncts are in bijection is also expressed by the notation

L(c)fdcf˜R(d). \frac{ L(c) \overset{f}{\longrightarrow} d }{ c \overset{\tilde f}{\longrightarrow} R(d) } \,.

For an object d𝒟d\in \mathcal{D}, the adjunct of the identity on LdL d is called the adjunction unit η d:dRLd\eta_d \;\colon\; d \longrightarrow R L d.

For an object c𝒞c \in \mathcal{C}, the adjunct of the identity on RcR c is called the adjunction counit ϵ c:LRcc\epsilon_c \;\colon\; L R c \longrightarrow c.

Adjunction units and counits turn out to encode the adjuncts of all other morphisms by the formulas

  • (Ldfc)˜=(dηRLdRfRc)\widetilde{(L d\overset{f}{\to}c)} = (d\overset{\eta}{\to} R L d \overset{R f}{\to} R c)

  • (dgRc)˜=(LdLgLRcϵc)\widetilde{(d\overset{g}{\to} R c)} = (L d \overset{L g}{\to} L R c \overset{\epsilon}{\to} c).

Definition

Let 𝒞,𝒟\mathcal{C}, \mathcal{D} be model categories. A pair of adjoint functors between them

(LR):𝒞RL𝒟 (L \dashv R) \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \underoverset {\underset{R}{\longrightarrow}} {\overset{L}{\longleftarrow}} {} \mathcal{D}

is called a Quillen adjunction (and LL,RR are called left/right Quillen functors, respectively) if the following equivalent conditions are satisfied

  1. LL preserves cofibrations and RR preserves fibrations;

  2. LL preserves acyclic cofibrations and RR preserves acyclic fibrations;

  3. LL preserves cofibrations and acylic cofibrations;

  4. RR preserves fibrations and acyclic fibrations.

Proposition

The conditions in def. are indeed all equivalent.

(Quillen 67, I.4, theorem 3)

Proof

First observe that

We discuss statement (i), statement (ii) is formally dual. So let f:ABf\colon A \to B be an acyclic cofibration in 𝒟\mathcal{D} and g:XYg \colon X \to Y a fibration in 𝒞\mathcal{C}. Then for every commuting diagram as on the left of the following, its (LR)(L\dashv R)-adjunct is a commuting diagram as on the right here:

A R(X) f R(g) B R(Y),L(A) X L(f) g L(B) Y. \array{ A &\longrightarrow& R(X) \\ {}^{\mathllap{f}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{R(g)}} \\ B &\longrightarrow& R(Y) } \;\;\;\;\;\; \,, \;\;\;\;\;\; \array{ L(A) &\longrightarrow& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{L(f)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{g}} \\ L(B) &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.

If LL preserves acyclic cofibrations, then the diagram on the right has a lift, and so the (LR)(L\dashv R)-adjunct of that lift is a lift of the left diagram. This shows that R(g)R(g) has the right lifting property against all acylic cofibrations and hence is a fibration. Conversely, if RR preserves fibrations, the same argument run from right to left gives that LL preserves acyclic fibrations.

Now by repeatedly applying (i) and (ii), all four conditions in question are seen to be equivalent.

Lemma

Let 𝒞RL𝒟\mathcal{C} \stackrel{\overset{L}{\longleftarrow}}{\underoverset{R}{\bot}{\longrightarrow}} \mathcal{D} be a Quillen adjunction, def. .

  1. For X𝒞X \in \mathcal{C} a fibrant object and Path(X)Path(X) a path space object (def. ), then R(Path(X))R(Path(X)) is a path space object for R(X)R(X).

  2. For X𝒞X \in \mathcal{C} a cofibrant object and Cyl(X)Cyl(X) a cylinder object (def. ), then L(Cyl(X))L(Cyl(X)) is a cylinder object for L(X)L(X).

Proof

Consider the second case, the first is formally dual.

First observe that L(XX)LXLXL(X \sqcup X) \simeq L X \sqcup L X because LL is left adjoint and hence preserves colimits, hence in particular coproducts.

Hence

L(XXCofCyl(X))=(L(X)L(X)CofL(Cyl(X))) L(X \sqcup X \overset{\in Cof}{\to} Cyl(X)) = (L(X) \sqcup L(X) \overset{\in Cof}{\to } L (Cyl(X)))

is a cofibration.

Second, with XX cofibrant i 0:XXXi_0 \colon X \to X \sqcup X is an acyclic cofibration (lemma ), and so then is

i 0:L(X)L(X)L(X). i_0 \; \colon \; L(X) \longrightarrow L(X) \sqcup L(X).

Therefore by two-out-of-three (def. ) LL preserves the weak equivalence Cyl(X)XCyl(X) \to X.

Proposition

(derived adjunction)

For 𝒞 QuRL𝒟\mathcal{C} \underoverset{\underset{R}{\longrightarrow}}{\overset{L}{\longleftarrow}}{\bot_{Qu}}\mathcal{D} a Quillen adjunction, def. , then also the corresponding left and right derived functors, def. , via cor. , form a pair of adjoint functors

Ho(𝒞)R𝕃LHo(𝒟). Ho(\mathcal{C}) \underoverset {\underset{\mathbb{R}R}{\longrightarrow}} {\overset{\mathbb{L}L}{\longleftarrow}} {\bot} Ho(\mathcal{D}) \,.

(Quillen 67, I.4 theorem 3)

Proof

By def. and lemma it is sufficient to see that for X,Y𝒞X, Y \in \mathcal{C} with XX cofibrant and YY fibrant, then there is a natural bijection

Hom 𝒞(LX,Y)/ Hom 𝒟(X,RY)/ . Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(L X , Y)/_\sim \simeq Hom_{\mathcal{D}}(X, R Y)/_\sim \,.

Since by the adjunction isomorphism for (LR)(L \dashv R) such a natural bijection exists before passing to homotopy classes ()/ (-)/_\sim, it is sufficient to see that this respects homotopy classes. To that end, use from lemma that with Cyl(Y)Cyl(Y) a cylinder object for YY, def. , then L(Cyl(Y))L(Cyl(Y)) is a cylinder object for L(Y)L(Y). This implies that left homotopies

(f Lg):LXY (f \Rightarrow_L g) \;\colon\; L X \longrightarrow Y

given by

η:Cyl(LX)=LCyl(X)Y \eta \;\colon\; Cyl(L X) = L Cyl(X) \longrightarrow Y

are in bijection to left homotopies

(f˜ Lg˜):XRY (\tilde f \Rightarrow_L \tilde g) \;\colon\; X \longrightarrow R Y

given by

η˜:Cyl(X)RX. \tilde \eta \;\colon\; Cyl(X) \longrightarrow R X \,.
Definition

For 𝒞,𝒟\mathcal{C}, \mathcal{D} two model categories, a Quillen adjunction (def.)

(LR):𝒞RL𝒟 (L \dashv R) \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \underoverset {\underset{R}{\longrightarrow}} {\overset{L}{\longleftarrow}} {\bot} \mathcal{D}

is called a Quillen equivalence, to be denoted

𝒞 QRL𝒟, \mathcal{C} \underoverset {\underset{R}{\longrightarrow}} {\overset{L}{\longleftarrow}} {\simeq_{\mathrlap{Q}}} \mathcal{D} \,,

if the following equivalent conditions hold.

  1. The right derived functor of RR (via prop. , corollary ) is an equivalence of categories

    R:Ho(𝒞)Ho(𝒟). \mathbb{R}R \colon Ho(\mathcal{C}) \overset{\simeq}{\longrightarrow} Ho(\mathcal{D}) \,.
  2. The left derived functor of LL (via prop. , corollary ) is an equivalence of categories

    𝕃L:Ho(𝒟)Ho(𝒞). \mathbb{L}L \colon Ho(\mathcal{D}) \overset{\simeq}{\longrightarrow} Ho(\mathcal{C}) \,.
  3. For every cofibrant object d𝒟d\in \mathcal{D}, the derived adjunction unit, hence the composite

    dηR(L(d))R(j L(d))R(P(L(d))) d \overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow} R(L(d)) \overset{R(j_{L(d)})}{\longrightarrow} R(P(L(d)))

    (of the adjunction unit with any fibrant replacement PP as in def. ) is a weak equivalence;

    and for every fibrant object c𝒞c \in \mathcal{C}, the derived adjunction counit, hence the composite

    L(Q(R(c)))L(p R(c))L(R(c))ϵc L(Q(R(c))) \overset{L(p_{R(c)})}{\longrightarrow} L(R(c)) \overset{\epsilon}{\longrightarrow} c

    (of the adjunction counit with any cofibrant replacement as in def. ) is a weak equivalence.

  4. For every cofibrant object d𝒟d \in \mathcal{D} and every fibrant object c𝒞c \in \mathcal{C}, a morphism dR(c)d \longrightarrow R(c) is a weak equivalence precisely if its adjunct morphism L(c)dL(c) \to d is:

    dW 𝒟R(c)L(d)W 𝒞c. \frac{ d \overset{\in W_{\mathcal{D}}}{\longrightarrow} R(c) }{ L(d) \overset{\in W_{\mathcal{C}}}{\longrightarrow} c } \,.
Proposition

The conditions in def. are indeed all equivalent.

(Quillen 67, I.4, theorem 3)

Proof

That 1)2)1) \Leftrightarrow 2) follows from prop. (if in an adjoint pair one is an equivalence, then so is the other).

To see the equivalence 1),2)3)1),2) \Leftrightarrow 3), notice (prop.) that a pair of adjoint functors is an equivalence of categories precisely if both the adjunction unit and the adjunction counit are natural isomorphisms. Hence it is sufficient to show that the morphisms called derived adjunction unit and derived adjunction counit above indeed represent the adjunction (co-)unit of (𝕃LR)(\mathbb{L}L \dashv \mathbb{R}R) in the homotopy category. We show this now for the adjunction unit, the case of the adjunction counit is formally dual.

To that end, first observe that for d𝒟 cd \in \mathcal{D}_c, then the defining commuting square for the left derived functor from def.

𝒟 c L 𝒞 γ P γ P,Q Ho(𝒟) 𝕃L Ho(𝒞) \array{ \mathcal{D}_c &\overset{L}{\longrightarrow}& \mathcal{C} \\ {}^{\mathllap{\gamma_P}}\downarrow &\swArrow_{\simeq}& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma_{P,Q}}} \\ Ho(\mathcal{D}) &\underset{\mathbb{L}L}{\longrightarrow}& Ho(\mathcal{C}) }

(using fibrant and fibrant/cofibrant replacement functors γ P\gamma_P, γ P,Q\gamma_{P,Q} from def. with their universal property from theorem , corollary ) gives that

(𝕃L)dPLPdPLdHo(𝒞), (\mathbb{L} L ) d \simeq P L P d \simeq P L d \;\;\;\; \in Ho(\mathcal{C}) \,,

where the second isomorphism holds because the left Quillen functor LL sends the acyclic cofibration j d:dPdj_d \colon d \to P d to a weak equivalence.

The adjunction unit of (𝕃LR)(\mathbb{L}L \dashv \mathbb{R}R) on PdHo(𝒞)P d \in Ho(\mathcal{C}) is the image of the identity under

Hom Ho(𝒞)((𝕃L)Pd,(𝕃L)Pd)Hom Ho(𝒞)(Pd,(R)(𝕃L)Pd). Hom_{Ho(\mathcal{C})}((\mathbb{L}L) P d, (\mathbb{L} L) P d) \overset{\simeq}{\to} Hom_{Ho(\mathcal{C})}(P d, (\mathbb{R}R)(\mathbb{L}L) P d) \,.

By the above and the proof of prop. , that adjunction isomorphism is equivalently that of (LR)(L \dashv R) under the isomorphism

Hom Ho(𝒞)(PLd,PLd)Hom(j Ld,id)Hom 𝒞(Ld,PLd)/ Hom_{Ho(\mathcal{C})}(P L d , P L d) \overset{Hom(j_{L d}, id)}{\longrightarrow} Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(L d, P L d)/_\sim

of lemma . Hence the derived adjunction unit is the (LR)(L \dashv R)-adjunct of

Ldj LdPLdidPLd, L d \overset{j_{L d}}{\longrightarrow} P L d \overset{id}{\to} P L d \,,

which indeed (by the formula for adjuncts) is

XηRLdR(j Ld)RPLd. X \overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow} R L d \overset{R (j_{L d})}{\longrightarrow} R P L d \,.

To see that 4)3)4) \Rightarrow 3):

Consider the weak equivalence LXj LXPLXL X \overset{j_{L X}}{\longrightarrow} P L X. Its (LR)(L \dashv R)-adjunct is

XηRLXRj LXRPLX X \overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow} R L X \overset{R j_{L X}}{\longrightarrow} R P L X

by assumption 4) this is again a weak equivalence, which is the requirement for the derived unit in 3). Dually for derived counit.

To see 3)4)3) \Rightarrow 4):

Consider any f:Ldcf \colon L d \to c a weak equivalence for cofibrant dd, firbant cc. Its adjunct f˜\tilde f sits in a commuting diagram

f˜: d η RLd Rf Rc = Rj Ld Rj c d W RPLd RPf RPc, \array{ \tilde f \colon & d &\overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& R L d &\overset{R f}{\longrightarrow}& R c \\ & {}^{\mathllap{=}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{R j_{L d}}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{R j_c}} \\ & d &\underset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& R P L d &\overset{R P f}{\longrightarrow}& R P c } \,,

where PfP f is any lift constructed as in def. .

This exhibits the bottom left morphism as the derived adjunction unit, hence a weak equivalence by assumption. But since ff was a weak equivalence, so is PfP f (by two-out-of-three). Thereby also RPfR P f and Rj cR j_c, are weak equivalences by Ken Brown's lemma and the assumed fibrancy of cc. Therefore by two-out-of-three (def. ) also the adjunct f˜\tilde f is a weak equivalence.

In certain situations the conditions on a Quillen equivalence simplify. For instance:

Proposition

If in a Quillen adjunction 𝒞 RL 𝒟 \array{\mathcal{C} &\underoverset{\underset{R}{\to}}{\overset{L}{\leftarrow}}{\bot}& \mathcal{D}} (def. ) the right adjoint RR “creates weak equivalences” (in that a morphism ff in 𝒞\mathcal{C} is a weak equivalence precisly if R(f)R(f) is) then (LR)(L \dashv R) is a Quillen equivalence (def. ) precisely already if for all cofibrant objects d𝒟d \in \mathcal{D} the plain adjunction unit

dηR(L(d)) d \overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow} R (L (d))

is a weak equivalence.

Proof

By prop. , generally, (LR)(L \dashv R) is a Quillen equivalence precisely if

  1. for every cofibrant object d𝒟d\in \mathcal{D}, the derived adjunction unit

    dηR(L(d))R(j L(d))R(P(L(d))) d \overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow} R(L(d)) \overset{R(j_{L(d)})}{\longrightarrow} R(P(L(d)))

    is a weak equivalence;

  2. for every fibrant object c𝒞c \in \mathcal{C}, the derived adjunction counit

    L(Q(R(c)))L(p R(c))L(R(c))ϵc L(Q(R(c))) \overset{L(p_{R(c)})}{\longrightarrow} L(R(c)) \overset{\epsilon}{\longrightarrow} c

    is a weak equivalence.

Consider the first condition: Since RR preserves the weak equivalence j L(d)j_{L(d)}, then by two-out-of-three (def. ) the composite in the first item is a weak equivalence precisely if η\eta is.

Hence it is now sufficient to show that in this case the second condition above is automatic.

Since RR also reflects weak equivalences, the composite in item two is a weak equivalence precisely if its image

R(L(Q(R(c))))R(L(p R(c)))R(L(R(c)))R(ϵ)R(c) R(L(Q(R(c)))) \overset{R(L(p_{R(c))})}{\longrightarrow} R(L(R(c))) \overset{R(\epsilon)}{\longrightarrow} R(c)

under RR is.

Moreover, assuming, by the above, that η Q(R(c))\eta_{Q(R(c))} on the cofibrant object Q(R(c))Q(R(c)) is a weak equivalence, then by two-out-of-three this composite is a weak equivalence precisely if the further composite with η\eta is

Q(R(c))η Q(R(c))R(L(Q(R(c))))R(L(p R(c)))R(L(R(c)))R(ϵ)R(c). Q(R(c)) \overset{\eta_{Q(R(c))}}{\longrightarrow} R(L(Q(R(c)))) \overset{R(L(p_{R(c))})}{\longrightarrow} R(L(R(c))) \overset{R(\epsilon)}{\longrightarrow} R(c) \,.

By the formula for adjuncts, this composite is the (LR)(L\dashv R)-adjunct of the original composite, which is just p R(c)p_{R(c)}

L(Q(R(c)))L(p R(c))L(R(c))ϵcQ(R(C))p R(c)R(c). \frac{ L(Q(R(c))) \overset{L(p_{R(c)})}{\longrightarrow} L(R(c)) \overset{\epsilon}{\longrightarrow} c }{ Q(R(C)) \overset{p_{R(c)}}{\longrightarrow} R(c) } \,.

But p R(c)p_{R(c)} is a weak equivalence by definition of cofibrant replacement.

The model structure on topological spaces

We now discuss how the category Top of topological spaces satisfies the axioms of abstract homotopy theory (model category) theory, def. .

Definition

Say that a continuous function, hence a morphism in Top, is

and hence

  • a acyclic classical cofibration if it is a classical cofibration as well as a classical weak equivalence;

  • a acyclic classical fibration if it is a classical fibration as well as a classical weak equivalence.

Write

W cl,Fib cl,Cof clMor(Top) W_{cl},\;Fib_{cl},\;Cof_{cl} \subset Mor(Top)

for the classes of these morphisms, respectively.

We first prove now that the classes of morphisms in def. satisfy the conditions for a model category structure, def. (after some lemmas, this is theorem below). Then we discuss the resulting classical homotopy category (below) and then a few variant model structures whose proof follows immediately along the line of the proof of Top QuillenTop_{Quillen}:

\,

Proposition

The classical weak equivalences, def. , satify two-out-of-three (def. ).

Proof

Since isomorphisms (of homotopy groups) satisfy 2-out-of-3, this property is directly inherited via the very definition of weak homotopy equivalence, def. .

Lemma

Every morphism f:XYf\colon X \longrightarrow Y in Top factors as a classical cofibration followed by an acyclic classical fibration, def. :

f:XCof clX^W clFib clY. f \;\colon\; X \stackrel{\in Cof_{cl}}{\longrightarrow} \hat X \stackrel{\in W_{cl} \cap Fib_{cl}}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.
Proof

By lemma the set I Top={S n1D n}I_{Top} = \{S^{n-1}\hookrightarrow D^n\} of topological generating cofibrations, def. , has small domains, in the sense of def. (the n-spheres are compact). Hence by the small object argument, prop. , ff factors as an I TopI_{Top}-relative cell complex, def. , hence just a plain relative cell complex, def. , followed by an I TopI_{Top}-injective morphisms, def. :

f:XCof clX^I TopInjY. f \;\colon\; X \stackrel{\in Cof_{cl}}{\longrightarrow} \hat X \stackrel{\in I_{Top} Inj}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.

By lemma the map X^Y\hat X \to Y is both a weak homotopy equivalence as well as a Serre fibration.

Lemma

Every morphism f:XYf\colon X \longrightarrow Y in Top factors as an acyclic classical cofibration followed by a fibration, def. :

f:XW clCof clX^Fib clY. f \;\colon\; X \stackrel{\in W_{cl} \cap Cof_{cl}}{\longrightarrow} \hat X \stackrel{\in Fib_{cl}}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.
Proof

By lemma the set J Top={D nD n×I}J_{Top} = \{D^n \hookrightarrow D^n\times I\} of topological generating acyclic cofibrations, def. , has small domains, in the sense of def. (the n-disks are compact). Hence by the small object argument, prop. , ff factors as an J TopJ_{Top}-relative cell complex, def. , followed by a J topJ_{top}-injective morphisms, def. :

f:XJ TopCellX^J TopInjY. f \;\colon\; X \stackrel{\in J_{Top} Cell}{\longrightarrow} \hat X \stackrel{\in J_{Top} Inj}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.

By definition this makes X^Y\hat X \to Y a Serre fibration, hence a fibration.

By lemma a relative J TopJ_{Top}-cell complex is in particular a relative I TopI_{Top}-cell complex. Hence XX^X \to \hat X is a classical cofibration. By lemma it is also a weak homotopy equivalence, hence a clasical weak equivalence.

Lemma

Every commuting square in Top with the left morphism a classical cofibration and the right morphism a fibration, def.

gCof cl fFib cl \array{ &\longrightarrow& \\ {}^{\mathllap{{g \in} \atop {Cof_{cl}}}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{{f \in }\atop Fib_{cl}}} \\ &\longrightarrow& }

admits a lift as soon as one of the two is also a classical weak equivalence.

Proof

A) If the fibration ff is also a weak equivalence, then lemma says that it has the right lifting property against the generating cofibrations I TopI_{Top}, and cor. implies the claim.

B) If the cofibration gg on the left is also a weak equivalence, consider any factorization into a relative J TopJ_{Top}-cell complex, def. , def. , followed by a fibration,

g:J TopCellFib cl, g \;\colon\; \stackrel{\in J_{Top} Cell}{\longrightarrow} \stackrel{\in Fib_{cl}}{\longrightarrow} \,,

as in the proof of lemma . By lemma the morphism J TopCell\overset{\in J_{Top} Cell}{\longrightarrow} is a weak homotopy equivalence, and so by two-out-of-three (prop. ) the factorizing fibration is actually an acyclic fibration. By case A), this acyclic fibration has the right lifting property against the cofibration gg itself, and so the retract argument, lemma gives that gg is a retract of a relative J TopJ_{Top}-cell complex. With this, finally cor. implies that ff has the right lifting property against gg.

Finally:

Proposition

The systems (Cof cl,W clFib cl)(Cof_{cl} , W_{cl} \cap Fib_{cl}) and (W clCof cl,Fib cl)(W_{cl} \cap Cof_{cl}, Fib_{cl}) from def. are weak factorization systems.

Proof

Since we have already seen the factorization property (lemma , lemma ) and the lifting properties (lemma ), it only remains to see that the given left/right classes exhaust the class of morphisms with the given lifting property.

For the classical fibrations this is by definition, for the the classical acyclic fibrations this is by lemma .

The remaining statement for Cof clCof_{cl} and W clCof clW_{cl}\cap Cof_{cl} follows from a general argument (here) for cofibrantly generated model categories (def. ), which we spell out:

So let f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y be in (I TopInj)Proj(I_{Top} Inj) Proj, we need to show that then ff is a retract (remark ) of a relative cell complex. To that end, apply the small object argument as in lemma to factor ff as

f:XI TopCellY^I TopInjY. f \;\colon \; X \overset{I_{Top} Cell}{\longrightarrow} \hat Y \overset{\in I_{Top} Inj}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.

It follows that ff has the left lifting property against Y^Y\hat Y \to Y, and hence by the retract argument (lemma ) it is a retract of XICellY^X \overset{I Cell}{\to} \hat Y. This proves the claim for Cof clCof_{cl}.

The analogous argument for W clCof clW_{cl} \cap Cof_{cl}, using the small object argument for J TopJ_{Top}, shows that every f(J TopInj)Projf \in (J_{Top} Inj) Proj is a retract of a J TopJ_{Top}-cell complex. By lemma and lemma a J TopJ_{Top}-cell complex is both an I TopI_{Top}-cell complex and a weak homotopy equivalence. Retracts of the former are cofibrations by definition, and retracts of the latter are still weak homotopy equivalences by lemma . Hence such ff is an acyclic cofibration.

In conclusion, prop. and prop. say that:

Theorem

The classes of morphisms in Mor(Top)Mor(Top) of def. ,

define a model category structure (def. ) Top QuillenTop_{Quillen}, the classical model structure on topological spaces or Serre-Quillen model structure .

In particular

  1. every object in Top QuillenTop_{Quillen} is fibrant;

  2. the cofibrant objects in Top QuillenTop_{Quillen} are the retracts of cell complexes.

Hence in particular the following classical statement is an immediate corollary:

Corollary

(Whitehead theorem)

Every weak homotopy equivalence (def. ) between topological spaces that are homeomorphic to a retract of a cell complex, in particular to a CW-complex (def. ), is a homotopy equivalence (def. ).

Proof

This is the “Whitehead theorem in model categories”, lemma , specialized to Top QuillenTop_{Quillen} via theorem .

In proving theorem we have in fact shown a bit more that stated. Looking back, all the structure of Top QuillenTop_{Quillen} is entirely induced by the set I TopI_{Top} (def. ) of generating cofibrations and the set J TopJ_{Top} (def. ) of generating acyclic cofibrations (whence the terminology). This phenomenon will keep recurring and will keep being useful as we construct further model categories, such as the classical model structure on pointed topological spaces (def. ), the projective model structure on topological functors (thm. ), and finally various model structures on spectra which we turn to in the section on stable homotopy theory.

Therefore we make this situation explicit:

Definition

A model category 𝒞\mathcal{C} (def. ) is called cofibrantly generated if there exists two subsets

I,JMor(𝒞) I, J \subset Mor(\mathcal{C})

of its class of morphisms, such that

  1. II and JJ have small domains according to def. ,

  2. the (acyclic) cofibrations of 𝒞\mathcal{C} are precisely the retracts, of II-relative cell complexes (JJ-relative cell complexes), def. .

Proposition

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} a cofibrantly generated model category, def. , with generating (acylic) cofibrations II (JJ), then its classes W,Fib,CofW, Fib, Cof of weak equivalences, fibrations and cofibrations are equivalently expressed as injective or projective morphisms (def. ) this way:

  1. Cof=(IInj)ProjCof = (I Inj) Proj

  2. WFib=IInjW \cap Fib = I Inj;

  3. WCof=(JInj)ProjW \cap Cof = (J Inj) Proj;

  4. Fib=JInjFib = J Inj;

Proof

It is clear from the definition that I(IInj)ProjI \subset (I Inj) Proj, so that the closure property of prop. gives an inclusion

Cof(IInj)Proj. Cof \subset (I Inj) Proj \,.

For the converse inclusion, let f(IInj)Projf \in (I Inj) Proj. By the small object argument, prop. , there is a factorization f:ICellIInjf\colon \overset{\in I Cell}{\longrightarrow}\overset{I Inj}{\longrightarrow}. Hence by assumption and by the retract argument lemma , ff is a retract of an II-relative cell complex, hence is in CofCof.

This proves the first statement. Together with the closure properties of prop. , this implies the second claim.

The proof of the third and fourth item is directly analogous, just with JJ replaced for II.

The classical homotopy category

With the classical model structure on topological spaces in hand, we now have good control over the classical homotopy category:

Definition

The Serre-Quillen classical homotopy category is the homotopy category, def. , of the classical model structure on topological spaces Top QuillenTop_{Quillen} from theorem : we write

Ho(Top)Ho(Top Quillen). Ho(Top) \coloneqq Ho(Top_{Quillen}) \,.
Remark

From just theorem , the definition (def. ) gives that

Ho(Top Quillen)(Top Retract(Cell))/ Ho(Top_{Quillen}) \simeq (Top_{Retract(Cell)})/_\sim

is the category whose objects are retracts of cell complexes (def. ) and whose morphisms are homotopy classes of continuous functions. But in fact more is true:

Theorem in itself implies that every topological space is weakly equivalent to a retract of a cell complex, def. . But by the existence of CW approximations, this cell complex may even be taken to be a CW complex.

(Better yet, there is Quillen equivalence to the classical model structure on simplicial sets which implies a functorial CW approximation |SingX|W clX{\vert Sing X\vert} \overset{\in W_{cl}}{\longrightarrow} X given by forming the geometric realization of the singular simplicial complex of XX.)

Hence the Serre-Quillen classical homotopy category is also equivalently the category of just the CW-complexes whith homotopy classes of continuous functions between them

Ho(Top Quillen) (Top Retract(Cell))/ (Top CW)/ . \begin{aligned} Ho(Top_{Quillen}) & \simeq (Top_{Retract(Cell)})/_\sim \\ & \simeq (Top_{CW})/_{\sim} \end{aligned} \,.

It follows that the universal property of the homotopy category (theorem )

Ho(Top Quillen)Top[W cl 1] Ho(Top_{Quillen}) \simeq Top[W_{cl}^{-1}]

implies that there is a bijection, up to natural isomorphism, between

  1. functors out of Top CWTop_{CW} which agree on homotopy-equivalent maps;

  2. functors out of all of TopTop which send weak homotopy equivalences to isomorphisms.

This statement in particular serves to show that two different axiomatizations of generalized (Eilenberg-Steenrod) cohomology theories are equivalent to each other. See at Introduction to Stable homotopy theory – S the section generalized cohomology functors (this prop.)

Beware that, by remark , what is not equivalent to Ho(Top Quillen)Ho(Top_{Quillen}) is the category

hTopTop/ hTop \coloneqq Top/_\sim

obtained from all topological spaces with morphisms the homotopy classes of continuous functions. This category is “too large”, the correct homotopy category is just the genuine full subcategory

Ho(Top Quillen)(Top Retract(Cell))/ Top/ hTop. Ho(Top_{Quillen}) \simeq (Top_{Retract(Cell)})/_\sim \hookrightarrow Top/_\sim \simeq hTop \,.

Beware also the ambiguity of terminology: “classical homotopy category” some literature refers to hTophTop instead of Ho(Top Quillen)Ho(Top_{Quillen}). However, here we never have any use for hTophTop and will not mention it again.

Proposition

Let XX be a CW-complex, def. . Then the standard topological cylinder of def.

XX(i 0,i 1)X×IX X \sqcup X \overset{(i_0,i_1)}{\longrightarrow} X\times I \longrightarrow X

(obtained by forming the product space with the standard topological interval I=[0,1]I = [0,1]) is indeed a cylinder object in the abstract sense of def. .

Proof

We describe the proof informally. It is immediate how to turn this into a formal proof, but the notation becomes tedious. (One place where it is spelled out completely is Ottina 14, prop. 2.9.)

So let X 0X 1X 2XX_0 \to X_1 \to X_2\to \cdots \to X be a presentation of XX as a CW-complex. Proceed by induction on the cell dimension.

First observe that the cylinder X 0×IX_0 \times I over X 0X_0 is a cell complex: First X 0X_0 itself is a disjoint union of points. Adding a second copy for every point (i.e. attaching along S 1D 0S^{-1}\to D^0) yields X 0X 0X_0 \sqcup X_0, then attaching an inteval between any two corresponding points (along S 0D 1S^0 \to D^1) yields X 0×IX_0 \times I.

So assume that for nn \in \mathbb{N} it has been shown that X n×IX_n \times I has the structure of a CW-complex of dimension (n+1)(n+1). Then for each cell of X n+1X_{n+1}, attach it twice to X n×IX_n \times I, once at X n×{0}X_n \times \{0\}, and once at X n×{1}X_n \times \{1\}.

The result is X n+1X_{n+1} with a hollow cylinder erected over each of its (n+1)(n+1)-cells. Now fill these hollow cylinders (along S n+1D n+1S^{n+1} \to D^{n+1}) to obtain X n+1×IX_{n+1}\times I.

This completes the induction, hence the proof of the CW-structure on X×IX\times I.

The construction also manifestly exhibits the inclusion XX(i 0,i 1)X \sqcup X \overset{(i_0,i_1)}{\longrightarrow} as a relative cell complex.

Finally, it is clear (prop. ) that X×IXX \times I \to X is a weak homotopy equivalence.

Conversely:

Proposition

Let XX be any topological space. Then the standard topological path space object (def. )

XX I(X δ 0,X δ 1)X×X X \longrightarrow X^I \overset{(X^{\delta_0}, X^{\delta_1})}{\longrightarrow} X \times X

(obtained by forming the mapping space, def. , with the standard topological interval I=[0,1]I = [0,1]) is indeed a path space object in the abstract sense of def. .

Proof

To see that const:XX Iconst \colon X\to X^I is a weak homotopy equivalence it is sufficient, by prop. , to exhibit a homotopy equivalence. Let the homotopy inverse be X δ 0:X IXX^{\delta_0} \colon X^I \to X. Then the composite

XconstX IX δ 0X X \overset{const}{\longrightarrow} X^I \overset{X^{\delta_0}}{\longrightarrow} X

is already equal to the identity. The other we round, the rescaling of paths provides the required homotopy

I×X I (t,γ)γ(t()) X I. \array{ I \times X^I &\overset{(t,\gamma)\mapsto \gamma(t\cdot(-))}{\longrightarrow}& X^I } \,.

To see that X IX×XX^I \to X\times X is a fibration, we need to show that every commuting square of the form

D n X I i 0 D n×I X×X \array{ D^n &\longrightarrow& X^I \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_0}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{} \\ D^n \times I &\longrightarrow& X \times X }

has a lift.

Now first use the adjunction (I×())() I(I \times (-))\dashv (-)^I from prop. to rewrite this equivalently as the following commuting square:

D nD n (i 0,i 0) (D n×I)(D n×I) (i 0,i 1) D n×I X. \array{ D^n \sqcup D^n &\overset{(i_0, i_0)}{\longrightarrow}& (D^n \times I) \sqcup (D^n \times I) \\ {}^{\mathllap{(i_0, i_1)}}\downarrow && \downarrow \\ D^n \times I &\longrightarrow& X } \,.

This square is equivalently (example ) a morphism out of the pushout

D n×ID nD n((D n×I)(D n×I))X. D^n \times I \underset{D^n \sqcup D^n }{\sqcup} \left((D^n \times I) \sqcup (D^n \times I)\right) \longrightarrow X \,.

By the same reasoning, a lift in the original diagram is now equivalently a lifting in

D n×ID nD n((D n×I)(D n×I)) X (D n×I)×I *. \array{ D^n \times I \underset{D^n \sqcup D^n }{\sqcup} \left((D^n \times I) \sqcup (D^n \times I)\right) &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ (D^n \times I)\times I &\longrightarrow& \ast } \,.

Inspection of the component maps shows that the left vertical morphism here is the inclusion into the square times D nD^n of three of its faces times D nD^n. This is homeomorphic to the inclusion D n+1D n+1×ID^{n+1} \to D^{n+1} \times I (as in remark ). Therefore a lift in this square exsists, and hence a lift in the original square exists.

Model structure on pointed spaces

A pointed object (X,x)(X,x) is of course an object XX equipped with a point x:*Xx \colon \ast \to X, and a morphism of pointed objects (X,x)(Y,y)(X,x) \longrightarrow (Y,y) is a morphism XYX \longrightarrow Y that takes xx to yy. Trivial as this is in itself, it is good to record some basic facts, which we do here.

Passing to pointed objects is also the first step in linearizing classical homotopy theory to stable homotopy theory. In particular, every category of pointed objects has a zero object, hence has zero morphisms. And crucially, if the original category had Cartesian products, then its pointed objects canonically inherit a non-cartesian tensor product: the smash product. These ingredients will be key below in the section on stable homotopy theory.

Definition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a category and let X𝒞X \in \mathcal{C} be an object.

The slice category 𝒞 /X\mathcal{C}_{/X} is the category whose

  • objects are morphisms A X\array{A \\ \downarrow \\ X} in 𝒞\mathcal{C};

  • morphisms are commuting triangles A B X\array{ A && \longrightarrow && B \\ & {}_{}\searrow && \swarrow \\ && X} in 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

Dually, the coslice category 𝒞 X/\mathcal{C}^{X/} is the category whose

  • objects are morphisms X A\array{X \\ \downarrow \\ A} in 𝒞\mathcal{C};

  • morphisms are commuting triangles X A B\array{ && X \\ & \swarrow && \searrow \\ A && \longrightarrow && B } in 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

There are the canonical forgetful functors

U:𝒞 /X,𝒞 X/𝒞 U \;\colon \; \mathcal{C}_{/X}, \mathcal{C}^{X/} \longrightarrow \mathcal{C}

given by forgetting the morphisms to/from XX.

We here focus on this class of examples:

Definition

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} a category with terminal object *\ast, the coslice category (def. ) 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} is the corresponding category of pointed objects: its

  • objects are morphisms in 𝒞\mathcal{C} of the form *xX\ast \overset{x}{\to} X (hence an object XX equipped with a choice of point; i.e. a pointed object);

  • morphisms are commuting triangles of the form

    * x y X f Y \array{ && \ast \\ & {}^{\mathllap{x}}\swarrow && \searrow^{\mathrlap{y}} \\ X && \overset{f}{\longrightarrow} && Y }

    (hence morphisms in 𝒞\mathcal{C} which preserve the chosen points).

Remark

In a category of pointed objects 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}, def. , the terminal object coincides with the initial object, both are given by *𝒞\ast \in \mathcal{C} itself, pointed in the unique way.

In this situation one says that *\ast is a zero object and that 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} is a pointed category.

It follows that also all hom-sets Hom 𝒞 */(X,Y)Hom_{\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}}(X,Y) of 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} are canonically pointed sets, pointed by the zero morphism

0:X!0!Y. 0 \;\colon\; X \overset{\exists !}{\longrightarrow} 0 \overset{\exists !}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.
Definition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a category with terminal object and finite colimits. Then the forgetful functor U:𝒞 */𝒞U \colon \mathcal{C}^{\ast/} \to \mathcal{C} from its category of pointed objects, def. , has a left adjoint

𝒞 */U() +𝒞 \mathcal{C}^{\ast/} \underoverset {\underset{U}{\longrightarrow}} {\overset{(-)_+}{\longleftarrow}} {\bot} \mathcal{C}

given by forming the disjoint union (coproduct) with a base point (“adjoining a base point”).

Proposition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a category with all limits and colimits. Then also the category of pointed objects 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}, def. , has all limits and colimits.

Moreover:

  1. the limits are the limits of the underlying diagrams in 𝒞\mathcal{C}, with the base point of the limit induced by its universal property in 𝒞\mathcal{C};

  2. the colimits are the limits in 𝒞\mathcal{C} of the diagrams with the basepoint adjoined.

Proof

It is immediate to check the relevant universal property. For details see at slice category – limits and colimits.

Example

Given two pointed objects (X,x)(X,x) and (Y,y)(Y,y), then:

  1. their product in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} is simply (X×Y,(x,y))(X\times Y, (x,y));

  2. their coproduct in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} has to be computed using the second clause in prop. : since the point *\ast has to be adjoined to the diagram, it is given not by the coproduct in 𝒞\mathcal{C}, but by the pushout in 𝒞\mathcal{C} of the form:

    * x X y (po) Y XY. \array{ \ast &\overset{x}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{y}}\downarrow &(po)& \downarrow \\ Y &\longrightarrow& X \vee Y } \,.

    This is called the wedge sum operation on pointed objects.

Generally for a set {X i} iI\{X_i\}_{i \in I} in Top */Top^{\ast/}

  1. their product is formed in TopTop as in example , with the new basepoint canonically induced;

  2. their coproduct is formed by the colimit in TopTop over the diagram with a basepoint adjoined, and is called the wedge sum iIX i\vee_{i \in I} X_i.

Example

For XX a CW-complex, def. then for every nn \in \mathbb{N} the quotient (example ) of its nn-skeleton by its (n1)(n-1)-skeleton is the wedge sum, def. , of nn-spheres, one for each nn-cell of XX:

X n/X n1iI nS n. X^n / X^{n-1} \simeq \underset{i \in I_n}{\vee} S^n \,.
Definition

For 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} a category of pointed objects with finite limits and finite colimits, the smash product is the functor

()():𝒞 */×𝒞 */𝒞 */ (-)\wedge(-) \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}^{\ast/} \times \mathcal{C}^{\ast/} \longrightarrow \mathcal{C}^{\ast/}

given by

XY*XY(X×Y), X \wedge Y \;\coloneqq\; \ast \underset{X\sqcup Y}{\sqcup} (X \times Y) \,,

hence by the pushout in 𝒞\mathcal{C}

XY (id X,y),(x,id Y) X×Y * XY. \array{ X \sqcup Y &\overset{(id_X,y),(x,id_Y) }{\longrightarrow}& X \times Y \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& X \wedge Y } \,.

In terms of the wedge sum from def. , this may be written concisely as

XY=X×YXY. X \wedge Y = \frac{X\times Y}{X \vee Y} \,.
Remark

For a general category 𝒞\mathcal{C} in def. , the smash product need not be associative, namely it fails to be associative if the functor ()×Z(-)\times Z does not preserve the quotients involved in the definition.

In particular this may happen for 𝒞=\mathcal{C} = Top.

A sufficient condition for ()×Z(-) \times Z to preserve quotients is that it is a left adjoint functor. This is the case in the smaller subcategory of compactly generated topological spaces, we come to this in prop. below.

These two operations are going to be ubiquituous in stable homotopy theory:

symbolnamecategory theory
XYX \vee Ywedge sumcoproduct in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}
XYX \wedge Ysmash producttensor product in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}
Example

For X,YTopX, Y \in Top, with X +,Y +Top */X_+,Y_+ \in Top^{\ast/}, def. , then

  • X +Y +(XY) +X_+ \vee Y_+ \simeq (X \sqcup Y)_+;

  • X +Y +(X×Y) +X_+ \wedge Y_+ \simeq (X \times Y)_+.

Proof

By example , X +Y +X_+ \vee Y_+ is given by the colimit in TopTop over the diagram

* X * * Y. \array{ && && \ast \\ && & \swarrow && \searrow \\ X &\,\,& \ast && && \ast &\,\,& Y } \,.

This is clearly X*YX \sqcup \ast \sqcup Y. Then, by definition

X +Y + (X*)×(X*)(X*)(Y*) X×YXY*XY* X×Y*. \begin{aligned} X_+ \wedge Y_+ & \simeq \frac{(X \sqcup \ast) \times (X \sqcup \ast)}{(X\sqcup \ast) \vee (Y \sqcup \ast)} \\ & \simeq \frac{X \times Y \sqcup X \sqcup Y \sqcup \ast}{X \sqcup Y \sqcup \ast} \\ & \simeq X \times Y \sqcup \ast \,. \end{aligned}
Example

Let 𝒞 */=Top */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} = Top^{\ast/} be pointed topological spaces. Then

I +Top */ I_+ \in Top^{\ast/}

denotes the standard interval object I=[0,1]I = [0,1] from def. , with a djoint basepoint adjoined, def. . Now for XX any pointed topological space, then

X(I +)=(X×I)/({x 0}×I) X \wedge (I_+) = (X \times I)/(\{x_0\} \times I)

is the reduced cylinder over XX: the result of forming the ordinary cyclinder over XX as in def. , and then identifying the interval over the basepoint of XX with the point.

(Generally, any construction in 𝒞\mathcal{C} properly adapted to pointed objects 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} is called the “reduced” version of the unpointed construction. Notably so for “reduced suspension” which we come to below.)

Just like the ordinary cylinder X×IX\times I receives a canonical injection from the coproduct XXX \sqcup X formed in TopTop, so the reduced cyclinder receives a canonical injection from the coproduct XXX \sqcup X formed in Top */Top^{\ast/}, which is the wedge sum from example :

XXX(I +). X \vee X \longrightarrow X \wedge (I_+) \,.
Example

For (X,x),(Y,y)(X,x),(Y,y) pointed topological spaces with YY a locally compact topological space, then the pointed mapping space is the topological subspace of the mapping space of def.

Maps((Y,y),(X,x)) *(X Y,const x) Maps((Y,y),(X,x))_\ast \hookrightarrow (X^Y, const_x)

on those maps which preserve the basepoints, and pointed by the map constant on the basepoint of XX.

In particular, the standard topological pointed path space object on some pointed XX (the pointed variant of def. ) is the pointed mapping space Maps(I +,X) *Maps(I_+,X)_\ast.

The pointed consequence of prop. then gives that there is a natural bijection

Hom Top */((Z,z)(Y,y),(X,x))Hom Top */((Z,z),Maps((Y,y),(X,x)) *) Hom_{Top^{\ast/}}((Z,z) \wedge (Y,y), (X,x)) \simeq Hom_{Top^{\ast/}}((Z,z), Maps((Y,y),(X,x))_\ast)

between basepoint-preserving continuous functions out of a smash product, def. , with pointed continuous functions of one variable into the pointed mapping space.

Example

Given a morphism f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y in a category of pointed objects 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}, def. , with finite limits and colimits,

  1. its fiber or kernel is the pullback of the point inclusion

    fib(f) X (pb) f * Y \array{ fib(f) &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Y }
  2. its cofiber or cokernel is the pushout of the point projection

    X f Y (po) * cofib(f). \array{ X &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ \downarrow &(po)& \downarrow \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& cofib(f) } \,.
Remark

In the situation of example , both the pullback as well as the pushout are equivalently computed in 𝒞\mathcal{C}. For the pullback this is the first clause of prop. . The second clause says that for computing the pushout in 𝒞\mathcal{C}, first the point is to be adjoined to the diagram, and then the colimit over the larger diagram

* X f Y * \array{ \ast \\ & \searrow \\ & & X &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ & & \downarrow && \\ & & \ast && }

be computed. But one readily checks that in this special case this does not affect the result. (The technical jargon is that the inclusion of the smaller diagram into the larger one in this case happens to be a final functor.)

Proposition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category and let X𝒞X \in \mathcal{C} be an object. Then both the slice category 𝒞 /X\mathcal{C}_{/X} as well as the coslice category 𝒞 X/\mathcal{C}^{X/}, def. , carry model structures themselves – the model structure on a (co-)slice category, where a morphism is a weak equivalence, fibration or cofibration iff its image under the forgetful functor UU is so in 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

In particular the category 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} of pointed objects, def. , in a model category 𝒞\mathcal{C} becomes itself a model category this way.

The corresponding homotopy category of a model category, def. , we call the pointed homotopy category Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}).

Proof

This is immediate:

By prop. the (co-)slice category has all limits and colimits. By definition of the weak equivalences in the (co-)slice, they satisfy two-out-of-three, def. , because the do in 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

Similarly, the factorization and lifting is all induced by 𝒞\mathcal{C}: Consider the coslice category 𝒞 X/\mathcal{C}^{X/}, the case of the slice category is formally dual; then if

X A f B \array{ && X \\ & \swarrow && \searrow \\ A && \underset{f}{\longrightarrow} && B }

commutes in 𝒞\mathcal{C}, and a factorization of ff exists in 𝒞\mathcal{C}, it uniquely makes this diagram commute

X A C B. \array{ && X \\ & \swarrow &\downarrow& \searrow \\ A &\longrightarrow& C & \longrightarrow& B } \,.

Similarly, if

A C B D \array{ A &\longrightarrow& C \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ B &\longrightarrow& D }

is a commuting diagram in 𝒞 X/\mathcal{C}^{X/}, hence a commuting diagram in 𝒞\mathcal{C} as shown, with all objects equipped with compatible morphisms from XX, then inspection shows that any lift in the diagram necessarily respects the maps from XX, too.

Example

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} any model category, with 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} its pointed model structure according to prop. , then the corresponding homotopy category (def. ) is, by remark , canonically enriched in pointed sets, in that its hom-functor is of the form

[,] *:Ho(𝒞 */) op×Ho(𝒞 */)Set */. [-,-]_\ast \;\colon\; Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/})^\op \times Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) \longrightarrow Set^{\ast/} \,.
Definition

Write Top Quillen */Top^{\ast/}_{Quillen} for the classical model structure on pointed topological spaces, obtained from the classical model structure on topological spaces Top QuillenTop_{Quillen} (theorem ) via the induced coslice model structure of prop. .

Its homotopy category, def. ,

Ho(Top */)Ho(Top Quillen */) Ho(Top^{\ast/}) \coloneqq Ho(Top_{Quillen}^{\ast/})

we call the classical pointed homotopy category.

Remark

The fibrant objects in the pointed model structure 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}, prop. , are those that are fibrant as objects of 𝒞\mathcal{C}. But the cofibrant objects in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} are now those for which the basepoint inclusion is a cofibration in XX.

For 𝒞 */=Top Quillen */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} = Top^{\ast/}_{Quillen} from def. , then the corresponding cofibrant pointed topological spaces are tyically referred to as spaces with non-degenerate basepoints or . Notice that the point itself is cofibrant in Top QuillenTop_{Quillen}, so that cofibrant pointed topological spaces are in particular cofibrant topological spaces.

While the existence of the model structure on Top */Top^{\ast/} is immediate, via prop. , for the discussion of topologically enriched functors (below) it is useful to record that this, too, is a cofibrantly generated model category (def. ), as follows:

Definition

Write

I Top */={S + n1(ι n) +D + n}Mor(Top */) I_{Top^{\ast/}} = \left\{ S^{n-1}_+ \overset{(\iota_n)_+}{\longrightarrow} D^n_+ \right\} \;\; \subset Mor(Top^{\ast/})

and

J Top */={D + n(id,δ 0) +(D n×I) +}Mor(Top */), J_{Top^{\ast/}} = \left\{ D^n_+ \overset{(id, \delta_0)_+}{\longrightarrow} (D^n \times I)_+ \right\} \;\;\; \subset Mor(Top^{\ast/}) \,,

respectively, for the sets of morphisms obtained from the classical generating cofibrations, def. , and the classical generating acyclic cofibrations, def. , under adjoining of basepoints (def. ).

Theorem

The sets I Top */I_{Top^{\ast/}} and J Top */J_{Top^{\ast/}} in def. exhibit the classical model structure on pointed topological spaces Top Quillen */Top^{\ast/}_{Quillen} of def. as a cofibrantly generated model category, def. .

(This is also a special case of a general statement about cofibrant generation of coslice model structures, see this proposition.)

Proof

Due to the fact that in J Top */J_{Top^{\ast/}} a basepoint is freely adjoined, lemma goes through verbatim for the pointed case, with J TopJ_{Top} replaced by J Top */J_{Top^{\ast/}}, as do the other two lemmas above that depend on point-set topology, lemma and lemma . With this, the rest of the proof follows by the same general abstract reasoning as above in the proof of theorem .

Model structure on compactly generated spaces

The category Top has the technical inconvenience that mapping spaces X YX^Y (def. ) satisfying the exponential property (prop. ) exist in general only for YY a locally compact topological space, but fail to exist more generally. In other words: Top is not cartesian closed. But cartesian closure is necessary for some purposes of homotopy theory, for instance it ensures that

  1. the smash product (def. ) on pointed topological spaces is associative (prop. below);

  2. there is a concept of topologically enriched functors with values in topological spaces, to which we turn below;

  3. geometric realization of simplicial sets preserves products.

The first two of these are crucial for the development of stable homotopy theory in the next section, the third is a great convenience in computations.

Now, since the homotopy theory of topological spaces only cares about the CW approximation to any topological space (remark ), it is plausible to ask for a full subcategory of Top which still contains all CW-complexes, still has all limits and colimits, still supports a model category structure constructed in the same way as above, but which in addition is cartesian closed, and preferably such that the model structure interacts well with the cartesian closure.

Such a full subcategory exists, the category of compactly generated topological spaces. This we briefly describe now.

Literature (Strickland 09)

\,

Definition

Let XX be a topological space.

A subset AXA \subset X is called compactly closed (or kk-closed) if for every continuous function f:KXf \colon K \longrightarrow X out of a compact Hausdorff space KK, then the preimage f 1(A)f^{-1}(A) is a closed subset of KK.

The space XX is called compactly generated if its closed subsets exhaust (hence coincide with) the kk-closed subsets.

Write

Top cgTop Top_{cg} \hookrightarrow Top

for the full subcategory of Top on the compactly generated topological spaces.

Definition

Write

TopkTop cgTop Top \overset{k}{\longrightarrow} Top_{cg} \hookrightarrow Top

for the functor which sends any topological space X=(S,τ)X = (S,\tau) to the topological space (S,kτ)(S, k \tau) with the same underlying set SS, but with open subsets kτk \tau the collection of all kk-open subsets with respect to τ\tau.

Lemma

Let XTop cgTopX \in Top_{cg} \hookrightarrow Top and let YTopY\in Top. Then continuous functions

XY X \longrightarrow Y

are also continuous when regarded as functions

Xk(Y) X \longrightarrow k(Y)

with kk from def. .

Proof

We need to show that for AXA \subset X a kk-closed subset, then the preimage f 1(A)Xf^{-1}(A) \subset X is closed subset.

Let ϕ:KX\phi \colon K \longrightarrow X be any continuous function out of a compact Hausdorff space KK. Since AA is kk-closed by assumption, we have that (fϕ) 1(A)=ϕ 1(f 1(A))K(f \circ \phi)^{-1}(A) = \phi^{-1}(f^{-1}(A))\subset K is closed in KK. This means that f 1(A)f^{-1}(A) is kk-closed in XX. But by the assumption that XX is compactly generated, it follows that f 1(A)f^{-1}(A) is already closed.

Corollary

For XTop cgX \in Top_{cg} there is a natural bijection

Hom Top(X,Y)Hom Top cg(X,k(Y)). Hom_{Top}(X,Y) \simeq Hom_{Top_{cg}}(X, k(Y)) \,.

This means equivalently that the functor kk (def. ) together with the inclusion from def. forms an pair of adjoint functors

Top cgkTop. Top_{cg} \underoverset {\underset{k}{\longleftarrow}} {\hookrightarrow} {\bot} Top \,.

This in turn means equivalently that Top cgTopTop_{cg} \hookrightarrow Top is a coreflective subcategory with coreflector kk. In particular kk is idemotent in that there are natural homeomorphisms

k(k(X))k(X). k(k(X))\simeq k(X) \,.

Hence colimits in Top cgTop_{cg} exist and are computed as in Top. Also limits in Top cgTop_{cg} exist, these are obtained by computing the limit in Top and then applying the functor kk to the result.

The following is a slight variant of def. , appropriate for the context of Top cgTop_{cg}.

Definition

For X,YTop cgX, Y \in Top_{cg} (def. ) the compactly generated mapping space X YTop cgX^Y \in Top_{cg} is the compactly generated topological space whose underlying set is the set C(Y,X)C(Y,X) of continuous functions f:YXf \colon Y \to X, and for which a subbase for its topology has elements U ϕ(K)U^{\phi(K)}, for UXU \subset X any open subset and ϕ:KY\phi \colon K \to Y a continuous function out of a compact Hausdorff space KK given by

U ϕ(κ){fC(Y,X)|f(ϕ(K))U}. U^{\phi(\kappa)} \coloneqq \left\{ f\in C(Y,X) | f(\phi(K)) \subset U \right\} \,.
Remark

If YY is (compactly generated and) a Hausdorff space, then the topology on the compactly generated mapping space X YX^Y in def. agrees with the compact-open topology of def. . Beware that it is common to say “compact-open topology” also for the topology of the compactly generated mapping space when YY is not Hausdorff. In that case, however, the two definitions in general disagree.

Proposition

The category Top cgTop_{cg} of def. is cartesian closed:

for every XTop cgX \in Top_{cg} then the operation X×()X\times (-) of forming the Cartesian product in Top cgTop_{cg} (which by cor. is kk applied to the usual product topological space) together with the operation () X(-)^X of forming the compactly generated mapping space (def. ) forms a pair of adjoint functors

Top cg() XX×()Top cg. Top_{cg} \underoverset {\underset{(-)^X}{\longrightarrow}} {\overset{X \times (-)}{\longleftarrow}} {\bot} Top_{cg} \,.

For proof see for instance (Strickland 09, prop. 2.12).

Corollary

For X,YTop cg */X, Y \in Top_{cg}^{\ast/}, the operation of forming the pointed mapping space (example ) inside the compactly generated mapping space of def.

Maps(Y,X) *fib(X Yev yX,x) Maps(Y,X)_\ast \coloneqq fib\left( X^Y \overset{ev_y}{\longrightarrow} X \;, x \right)

is left adjoint to the smash product operation on pointed compactly generated topological spaces.

Top cg */Maps(Y,) *Y()Top cg */. Top_{cg}^{\ast/} \underoverset {\underset{Maps(Y,-)_\ast}{\longrightarrow}} {\overset{Y \wedge (-)}{\longleftarrow}} {\bot} Top_{cg}^{\ast/} \,.
Corollary

For II a small category and X :ITop cg */X_\bullet \colon I \to Top^{\ast/}_{cg} a diagram, then the compactly generated mapping space construction from def. preserves limits in its covariant argument and sends colimits in its contravariant argument to limits:

Maps(X,lim iY i) *lim iMaps(X,Y i) * Maps(X,\underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i Y_i)_\ast \;\simeq\; \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i Maps(X, Y_i)_\ast

and

Maps(lim iX i,Y) *lim iMaps(X i,Y) *. Maps( \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_i X_i, \; Y )_\ast \simeq \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i Maps( X_i, Y )_\ast \,.
Proof

The first statement is an immediate implication of Maps(X,) *Maps(X,-)_\ast being a right adjoint, according to cor. .

For the second statement, we use that by def. a compactly generated topological space is uniquely determined if one knows all continuous functions out of compact Hausdorff spaces into it. Hence it is sufficient to show that there is a natural isomorphism

Hom Top cg */(K,Maps(lim iX i,Y) *)Hom Top cg */(K,lim iMaps(X i,Y) *) Hom_{Top_{cg}^{\ast/}}\left( K,\; Maps( \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_i X_i, \; Y )_\ast \right) \simeq Hom_{Top^{\ast/}_{cg}}\left( K, \; \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i Maps( X_i, Y )_\ast \right)

for KK any compact Hausdorff space.

With this, the statement follows by cor. and using that ordinary hom-sets take colimits in the first argument and limits in the second argument to limits:

Hom Top cg */(K,Maps(lim iX i,Y) *) Hom Top cg */(Klim iX i,Y) Hom Top cg */(lim i(KX i),Y) lim i(Hom Top cg */(KX i,Y)) lim iHom Top cg */(K,Maps(X i,Y) *) Hom Top cg */(K,lim iMaps(X i,Y) *). \begin{aligned} Hom_{Top^{\ast/}_{cg}} \left( K, \; Maps(\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_i X_i,\; Y)_\ast \right) & \simeq Hom_{Top^{\ast/}_{cg}} \left( K \wedge \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_i X_i,\; Y \right) \\ & \simeq Hom_{Top^{\ast/}_{cg}} \left( \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_i (K \wedge X_i) ,\; Y \right) \\ & \simeq \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i \left( Hom_{Top^{\ast/}_{cg}} ( K \wedge X_i, \; Y ) \right) \\ & \simeq \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i Hom_{Top^{\ast/}_{cg}}( K, \; Maps(X_i,Y)_\ast ) \\ & \simeq Hom_{Top^{\ast/}_{cg}} \left( K,\; \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i Maps(X_i,Y)_\ast \right) \end{aligned} \,.

Moreover, compact generation fixes the associativity of the smash product (remark ):

Proposition

On pointed (def. ) compactly generated topological spaces (def. ) the smash product (def. )

()():Top cg */×Top cg */Top cg */ (-)\wedge (-) \;\colon\; Top_{cg}^{\ast/} \times Top_{cg}^{\ast/} \longrightarrow Top_{cg}^{\ast/}

is associative and the 0-sphere is a tensor unit for it.

Proof

Since ()×X(-)\times X is a left adjoint by prop. , it presevers colimits and in particular quotient space projections. Therefore with X,Y,ZTop cg */X, Y, Z \in Top_{cg}^{\ast/} then

(XY)Z =X×YX×{y}{x}×Y×Z(XY)×{z}{[x]=[y]}×Z X×Y×ZX×{y}×Z{x}×Y×ZX×Y×{z} X×Y×ZX×{y}×Z{x}×Y×ZX×Y×{z}. \begin{aligned} (X \wedge Y) \wedge Z & = \frac{ \frac{X\times Y}{X \times\{y\} \sqcup \{x\}\times Y} \times Z }{ (X \wedge Y)\times \{z\} \sqcup \{[x] = [y]\} \times Z} \\ & \simeq \frac{\frac{X \times Y \times Z}{X \times \{y\}\times Z \sqcup \{x\}\times Y \times Z}}{ X \times Y \times \{z\} } \\ &\simeq \frac{X\times Y \times Z}{X \times \{y\}\times Z \sqcup \{x\}\times Y \times Z \sqcup X \times Y \times \{z\}} \end{aligned} \,.

The analogous reasoning applies to yield also X(YZ)X×Y×ZX×{y}×Z{x}×Y×ZX×Y×{z}X \wedge (Y\wedge Z) \simeq \frac{X\times Y \times Z}{X \times \{y\}\times Z \sqcup \{x\}\times Y \times Z \sqcup X \times Y \times \{z\}}.

The second statement follows directly with prop. .

Remark

Corollary together with prop. says that under the smash product the category of pointed compactly generated topological spaces is a closed symmetric monoidal category with tensor unit the 0-sphere.

(Top cg */,,S 0),. (Top_{cg}^{\ast/}, \wedge, S^0) ,.

Notice that by prop. also unpointed compactly generated spaces under Cartesian product form a closed symmetric monoidal category, hence a cartesian closed category

(Top cg,×,*). (Top_{cg}, \times , \ast) \,.

The fact that Top cg */Top_{cg}^{\ast/} is still closed symmetric monoidal but no longer Cartesian exhibits Top cg */Top_{cg}^{\ast/} as being “more linear” than Top cgTop_{cg}. The “full linearization” of Top cgTop_{cg} is the closed symmteric monoidal category of structured spectra under smash product of spectra which we discuss in section 1.

Due to the idempotency kkkk \circ k \simeq k (cor. ) it is useful to know plenty of conditions under which a given topological space is already compactly generated, for then applying kk to it does not change it and one may continue working as in TopTop.

Example

Every CW-complex is compactly generated.

Proof

Since a CW-complex is a Hausdorff space, by prop. and prop. its kk-closed subsets are precisely those whose intersection with every compact subspace is closed.

Since a CW-complex XX is a colimit in Top over attachments of standard n-disks D n iD^{n_i} (its cells), by the characterization of colimits in TopTop (prop.) a subset of XX is open or closed precisely if its restriction to each cell is open or closed, respectively. Since the nn-disks are compact, this implies one direction: if a subset AA of XX intersected with all compact subsets is closed, then AA is closed.

For the converse direction, since a CW-complex is a Hausdorff space and since compact subspaces of Hausdorff spaces are closed, the intersection of a closed subset with a compact subset is closed.

For completeness we record further classes of examples:

(Lewis 78, p. 148)

Recall that by corollary , all colimits of compactly generated spaces are again compactly generated.

Example

The product topological space of a CW-complex with a compact CW-complex, and more generally with a locally compact CW-complex, is compactly generated.

(Hatcher “Topology of cell complexes”, theorem A.6)

More generally:

Proposition

For XX a compactly generated space and YY a locally compact Hausdorff space, then the product topological space X×YX\times Y is compactly generated.

e.g. (Strickland 09, prop. 26)

Finally we check that the concept of homotopy and homotopy groups does not change under passing to compactly generated spaces:

Proposition

For every topological space XX, the canonical function k(X)Xk(X) \longrightarrow X (the adjunction counit) is a weak homotopy equivalence.

Proof

By example , example and lemma , continuous functions S nk(X)S^n \to k(X) and their left homotopies S n×Ik(X)S^n \times I \to k(X) are in bijection with functions S nXS^n \to X and their homotopies S n×IXS^n \times I \to X.

Theorem

(model structure on compactly generated topological spaces)

The restriction of the model category structure on Top QuillenTop_{Quillen} from theorem along the inclusion Top cgTopTop_{cg} \hookrightarrow Top of def. is still a model category structure, which is cofibrantly generated by the same sets I TopI_{Top} (def. ) and J TopJ_{Top} (def. ). The k-ification coreflection of cor. is a Quillen equivalence (def. )

(Top cg) QuillenkTop Quillen. (Top_{cg})_{Quillen} \underoverset {\underset{k}{\longleftarrow}} {\hookrightarrow} {\bot} Top_{Quillen} \,.
Proof

By example , the sets I TopI_{Top} and J TopJ_{Top} are indeed in Mor(Top cg)Mor(Top_{cg}). By example all arguments above about left homotopies between maps out of these basic cells go through verbatim in Top cgTop_{cg}. Hence the three technical lemmas above depending on actual point-set topology, topology, lemma , lemma and lemma , go through verbatim as before. Accordingly, since the remainder of the proof of theorem of Top QuillenTop_{Quillen} follows by general abstract arguments from these, it also still goes through verbatim for (Top cg) Quillen(Top_{cg})_{Quillen} (repeatedly use the small object argument and the retract argument to establish the two weak factorization systems).

Hence the (acyclic) cofibrations in (Top cg) Quillen(Top_{cg})_{Quillen} are identified with those in Top QuillenTop_{Quillen}, and so the inclusion is a part of a Quillen adjunction (def. ). To see that this is a Quillen equivalence (def. ), it is sufficient to check that for XX a compactly generated space then a continuous function f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y is a weak homotopy equivalence (def. ) precisely if the adjunct f˜:Xk(Y)\tilde f \colon X \to k(Y) is a weak homotopy equivalence. But, by lemma , f˜\tilde f is the same function as ff, just considered with different codomain. Hence the result follows with prop. .

\,

Compactly generated weakly Hausdorff topological spaces

While the inclusion Top cgTopTop_{cg} \hookrightarrow Top of def. does satisfy the requirement that it gives a cartesian closed category with all limits and colimits and containing all CW-complexes, one may ask for yet smaller subcategories that still share all these properties but potentially exhibit further convenient properties still.

A popular choice introduced in (McCord 69) is to add the further restriction to topological spaces which are not only compactly generated but also weakly Hausdorff. This was motivated from (Steenrod 67) where compactly generated Hausdorff spaces were used by the observation ((McCord 69, section 2)) that Hausdorffness is not preserved my many colimit operations, notably not by forming quotient spaces.

On the other hand, in above we wouldn’t have imposed Hausdorffness in the first place. More intrinsic advantages of Top cgwHTop_{cgwH} over Top cgTop_{cg} are the following:

  • every pushout of a morphism in Top cgwHTopTop_{cgwH} \hookrightarrow Top along a closed subspace inclusion in TopTop is again in Top cgwHTop_{cgwH}

  • in Top cgwHTop_{cgwH} quotient spaces are not only preserved by cartesian products (as is the case for all compactly generated spaces due to X×()X\times (-) being a left adjoint, according to cor. ) but by all pullbacks

  • in Top cgwHTop_{cgwH} the regular monomorphisms are the closed subspace inclusions

We will not need this here or in the following sections, but we briefly mention it for completenes:

Definition

A topological space XX is called weakly Hausdorff if for every continuous function

f:KX f \;\colon\; K \longrightarrow X

out of a compact Hausdorff space KK, its image f(K)Xf(K) \subset X is a closed subset of XX.

Proposition

Every Hausdorff space is a weakly Hausdorff space, def. .

Proposition

For XX a weakly Hausdorff topological space, def. , then a subset AXA \subset X is kk-closed, def. , precisely if for every subset KXK \subset X that is compact Hausdorff with respect to the subspace topology, then the intersection KAK \cap A is a closed subset of XX.

e.g. (Strickland 09, lemma 1.4 (c))

Topological enrichment

So far the classical model structure on topological spaces which we established in theorem , as well as the projective model structures on topologically enriched functors induced from it in theorem , concern the hom-sets, but not the hom-spaces (def. ), i.e. the model structure so far has not been related to the topology on hom-spaces. The following statements say that in fact the model structure and the enrichment by topology on the hom-spaces are compatible in a suitable sense: we have an “enriched model category”. This implies in particular that the product/hom-adjunctions are Quillen adjunctions, which is crucial for a decent discusson of the derived functors of the suspension/looping adjunction below.

Definition

Let i 1:X 1Y 1i_1 \colon X_1 \to Y_1 and i 2:X 2Y 2i_2 \colon X_2 \to Y_2 be morphisms in Top cgTop_{cg}, def. . Their pushout product

i 1i 2((id,i 2),(i 1,id)) i_1\Box i_2 \coloneqq ((id, i_2), (i_1,id))

is the universal morphism in the following diagram

X 1×X 2 (i 1,id) (id,i 2) Y 1×X 2 (po) X 1×Y 2 (Y 1×X 2)X 1×X 2(X 1×Y 2) ((id,i 2),(i 1,id)) Y 1×Y 2 \array{ && X_1 \times X_2 \\ & {}^{\mathllap{(i_1,id)}}\swarrow && \searrow^{\mathrlap{(id,i_2)}} \\ Y_1 \times X_2 && (po) && X_1 \times Y_2 \\ & {}_{\mathllap{}}\searrow && \swarrow \\ && (Y_1 \times X_2) \underset{X_1 \times X_2}{\sqcup} (X_1 \times Y_2) \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{((id, i_2), (i_1,id))}} \\ && Y_1 \times Y_2 }
Example

If i 1:X 1Y 1i_1 \colon X_1 \hookrightarrow Y_1 and i 2:X 2Y 2i_2 \colon X_2 \hookrightarrow Y_2 are inclusions, then their pushout product i 1i 2i_1 \Box i_2 from def. is the inclusion

(X 1×Y 2Y 1×X 2)Y 1×Y 2. \left( X_1 \times Y_2 \;\cup\; Y_1 \times X_2 \right) \hookrightarrow Y_1 \times Y_2 \,.

For instance

({0}I)({0}I) \left( \{0\} \hookrightarrow I \right) \Box \left( \{0\} \hookrightarrow I \right)

is the inclusion of two adjacent edges of a square into the square.

Example

The pushout product with an initial morphism is just the ordinary Cartesian product functor

(X)()X×(), (\emptyset \to X) \Box (-) \simeq X \times (-) \,,

i.e.

(X)(AfB)(X×AX×fX×B). (\emptyset \to X) \Box (A \overset{f}{\to} B) \simeq (X\times A \overset{X \times f}{\longrightarrow} X \times B ) \,.
Proof

The product topological space with the empty space is the empty space, hence the map ×A(id,f)×B\emptyset \times A \overset{(id,f)}{\longrightarrow} \emptyset \times B is an isomorphism, and so the pushout in the pushout product is X×AX \times A. From this one reads off the universal map in question to be X×fX \times f:

×A X×A (po) ×B X×A ((id,f),!) X×B. \array{ && \emptyset \times A \\ & {}^{\mathllap{}}\swarrow && \searrow^{\mathrlap{\simeq}} \\ X \times A && (po) && \emptyset \times B \\ & {}_{\mathllap{\simeq}}\searrow && \swarrow \\ && X \times A \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{((id, f), \exists !)}} \\ && X \times B } \,.
Example

With

I Top:{S n1i nD n}andJ Top:{D nj nD n×I} I_{Top} \colon \{ S^{n-1} \overset{i_n}{\hookrightarrow} D^n\} \;\;\; and \;\;\; J_{Top} \colon \{ D^n \overset{j_n}{\hookrightarrow} D^n \times I\}

the generating cofibrations (def. ) and generating acyclic cofibrations (def. ) of (Top cg) Quillen(Top_{cg})_{Quillen} (theorem ), then their pushout-products (def. ) are

i n 1i n 2 i n 1+n 2 i n 1j n 2 j n 1+n 2. \begin{aligned} i_{n_1} \Box i_{n_2} & \simeq i_{n_1 + n_2} \\ i_{n_1} \Box j_{n_2} & \simeq j_{n_1 + n_2} \end{aligned} \,.
Proof

To see this, it is profitable to model n-disks and n-spheres, up to homeomorphism, as nn-cubes D n[0,1] n nD^\n \simeq [0,1]^n \subset \mathbb{R}^n and their boundaries S n1[0,1] nS^{n-1} \simeq \partial [0,1]^n . For the idea of the proof, consider the situation in low dimensions, where one readily sees pictorially that

i 1i 1:(=||) i_1 \Box i_1 \;\colon\; \left(\;\; = \;\;\cup\;\; \vert\vert\;\;\right) \hookrightarrow \Box

and

i 1j 0:(=|). i_1 \Box j_0 \;\colon\; \left(\;\; = \;\;\cup\;\; \vert \;\; \right) \hookrightarrow \Box \,.

Generally, D nD^n may be represented as the space of nn-tuples of elements in [0,1][0,1], and S nS^n as the suspace of tuples for which at least one of the coordinates is equal to 0 or to 1.

Accordingly, S n 1×D n 2D n 1+n 2S^{n_1} \times D^{n_2} \hookrightarrow D^{n_1 + n_2} is the subspace of (n 1+n 2)(n_1+n_2)-tuples, such that at least one of the first n 1n_1 coordinates is equal to 0 or 1, while D n 1×S n 2D n 1+n 2D^{n_1} \times S^{n_2} \hookrightarrow D^{n_1+ n_2} is the subspace of (n 1+n 2)(n_1 + n_2)-tuples such that east least one of the last n 2n_2 coordinates is equal to 0 or to 1. Therefore

S n 1×D n 2D n 1×S n 2S n 1+n 2. S^{n_1} \times D^{n_2} \cup D^{n_1} \times S^{n_2} \simeq S^{n_1 + n_2} \,.

And of course it is clear that D n 1×D n 2D n 1+n 2D^{n_1} \times D^{n_2} \simeq D^{n_1 + n_2}. This shows the first case.

For the second, use that S n 1×D n 2×IS^{n_1} \times D^{n_2} \times I is contractible to S n 1×D n 2S^{n_1} \times D^{n_2} in D n 1×D n 2×ID^{n_1} \times D^{n_2} \times I, and that S n 1×D n 2S^{n_1} \times D^{n_2} is a subspace of D n 1×D n 2D^{n_1} \times D^{n_2}.

Definition

Let i:ABi \colon A \to B and p:XYp \colon X \to Y be two morphisms in Top cgTop_{cg}, def. . Their pullback powering is

p i(p B,X i) p^{\Box i} \coloneqq (p^B, X^i)

being the universal morphism in

X B (p B,X i) Y B×Y AX A Y B (pb) X A Y i p A Y A \array{ && X^B \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(p^B, X^i)}} \\ && Y^B \underset{Y^A}{\times} X^A \\ & \swarrow && \searrow \\ Y^B && (pb) && X^A \\ & {}_{\mathllap{Y^i}}\searrow && \swarrow_{\mathrlap{p^A}} \\ && Y^A }
Proposition

Let i 1,i 2,pi_1, i_2 , p be three morphisms in Top cgTop_{cg}, def. . Then for their pushout-products (def. ) and pullback-powerings (def. ) the following lifting properties are equivalent (“Joyal-Tierney calculus”):

i 1i 2 has LLP against p i 1 has LLP against p i 2 i 2 has LLP against p i 1. \array{ & i_1 \Box i_2 & \text{has LLP against} & p \\ \Leftrightarrow & i_1 & \text{has LLP against} & p^{\Box i_2} \\ \Leftrightarrow & i_2 & \text{has LLP against} & p^{\Box i_1} } \,.
Proof

We claim that by the cartesian closure of Top cgTop_{cg}, and carefully collecting terms, one finds a natural bijection between commuting squares and their lifts as follows:

Q f X B i 1 p i 2 P (g 1,g 2) Y B×Y AX AQ×BQ×AP×A (f˜,g˜ 2) X i 1i 2 p P×B g˜ 1 Y, \array{ Q &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& X^B \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_1}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p^{\Box i_2}}} \\ P &\underset{(g_1,g_2)}{\longrightarrow}& Y^B \underset{Y^A}{\times} X^A } \;\;\;\;\;\;\; \leftrightarrow \;\;\;\;\;\;\; \array{ Q \times B \underset{Q \times A}{\sqcup} P \times A &\overset{(\tilde f, \tilde g_2)}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_1 \Box i_2}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ P \times B & \underset{\tilde g_1}{\longrightarrow} & Y } \,,

where the tilde denotes product/hom-adjuncts, for instance

Pg 1Y BP×Bg˜ 1Y \frac{ P \overset{g_1}{\longrightarrow} Y^B }{ P \times B \overset{\tilde g_1}{\longrightarrow} Y }

etc.

To see this in more detail, observe that both squares above each represent two squares from the two components into the fiber product and out of the pushout, respectively, as well as one more square exhibiting the compatibility condition on these components:

Q f X B i 1 p i 2 P (g 1,g 2) Y B×Y AX A {Q f X B i 1 p B P g 1 Y B,Q f X B i 1 X i 2 P g 1 X A,P g 2 X A g 1 p A Y B Y i 2 Y A} {Q×B f˜ X (i 1,id) p P×B g˜ 2 Y,Q×A (id,i 2) Q×B (i 1,id) f˜ P×A g˜ 2 X,P×A g˜ 2 X (id,i 2) p P×B g˜ 1 Y} Q×BQ×AP×A (f˜,g˜ 2) X i 1i 2 p P×B g˜ 1 Y. \begin{aligned} & \;\;\;\; \array{ Q &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& X^B \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_1}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p^{\Box i_2}}} \\ P &\underset{(g_1,g_2)}{\longrightarrow}& Y^B \underset{Y^A}{\times} X^A } \\ \simeq & \;\;\;\; \left\{ \;\;\;\; \array{ Q &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& X^B \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_1}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p^B}} \\ P &\underset{g_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y^B } \;\;\;\;\; \,, \;\;\;\;\; \array{ Q &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& X^B \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_1}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{X^{i_2}}} \\ P &\underset{g_1}{\longrightarrow}& X^A } \;\;\;\;\; \,, \;\;\;\;\; \array{ P &\overset{g_2}{\longrightarrow}& X^A \\ {}^{\mathllap{g_1}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p^A}} \\ Y^B &\underset{Y^{i_2}}{\longrightarrow}& Y^A } \;\;\;\;\; \right\} \\ \leftrightarrow & \;\;\;\; \left\{ \;\;\;\;\; \array{ Q \times B &\overset{\tilde f}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{(i_1,id)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ P \times B &\underset{\tilde g_2}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \;\;\;\;\; \,, \;\;\;\;\; \array{ Q \times A &\overset{(id,i_2)}{\longrightarrow}& Q \times B \\ {}^{\mathllap{(i_1,id)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\tilde f}} \\ P \times A &\underset{\tilde g_2}{\longrightarrow}& X } \;\;\;\;\; \,, \;\;\;\;\; \array{ P \times A &\overset{\tilde g_2}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{(id,i_2)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ P \times B &\underset{\tilde g_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \;\;\;\;\; \right\} \\ \simeq & \;\;\;\; \array{ Q \times B \underset{Q \times A}{\sqcup} P \times A &\overset{(\tilde f, \tilde g_2)}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{i_1 \Box i_2}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ P \times B & \underset{\tilde g_1}{\longrightarrow} & Y } \end{aligned} \,.
Proposition

The pushout-product in Top cgTop_{cg} (def. ) of two classical cofibrations is a classical cofibration:

Cof clCof clCof cl. Cof_{cl} \Box Cof_{cl} \subset Cof_{cl} \,.

If one of them is acyclic, then so is the pushout-product:

Cof cl(W clCof cl)W clCof cl. Cof_{cl} \Box (W_{cl} \cap Cof_{cl}) \subset W_{cl}\cap Cof_{cl} \,.
Proof

Regarding the first point:

By example we have

I TopI TopI Top I_{Top} \Box I_{Top} \subset I_{Top}

Hence

I TopI Top has LLP against W clFib cl I Top has LLP against (W clFib cl) I Top Cof cl has LLP against (W clFib cl) I Top I TopCof cl has LLP against W clFib cl I Top has LLP against (W clFib cl) Cof cl Cof cl has LLP against (W clFib cl) Cof cl Cof clCof cl has LLP against W clFib cl, \array{ & I_{Top} \Box I_{Top} & \text{has LLP against} & W_{cl} \cap Fib_{cl} \\ \Leftrightarrow & I_{Top} & \text{has LLP against} & (W_{cl} \cap Fib_{cl})^{\Box I_{Top}} \\ \Rightarrow & Cof_{cl} & \text{has LLP against} & (W_{cl} \cap Fib_{cl})^{\Box I_{Top}} \\ \Leftrightarrow & I_{Top} \Box Cof_{cl} & \text{has LLP against} & W_{cl} \cap Fib_{cl} \\ \Leftrightarrow & I_{Top} & \text{has LLP against} & (W_{cl} \cap Fib_{cl})^{Cof_{cl}} \\ \Rightarrow & Cof_{cl} & \text{has LLP against} & (W_{cl} \cap Fib_{cl})^{Cof_{cl}} \\ \Leftrightarrow & Cof_{cl} \Box \Cof_{cl} & \text{has LLP against} & W_{cl} \cap Fib_{cl} } \,,

where all logical equivalences used are those of prop. and where all implications appearing are by the closure property of lifting problems, prop. .

Regarding the second point: By example we moreover have

I TopJ TopJ Top I_{Top} \Box J_{Top} \subset J_{Top}

and the conclusion follows by the same kind of reasoning.

Remark

In model category theory the property in proposition is referred to as saying that the model category (Top cg) Quillen(Top_{cg})_{Quillen} from theorem

  1. is a monoidal model category with respect to the Cartesian product on Top cgTop_{cg};

  2. is an enriched model category, over itself.

A key point of what this entails is the following:

Proposition

For X(Top cg) QuillenX \in (Top_{cg})_{Quillen} cofibrant (a retract of a cell complex) then the product-hom-adjunction for YY (prop. ) is a Quillen adjunction

(Top cg) Quillen() XX×()(Top cg) Quillen. (Top_{cg})_{Quillen} \underoverset \underset{(-)^X}{\longrightarrow} \overset{X \times (-)}{\longleftarrow} {\bot} (Top_{cg})_{Quillen} \,.
Proof

By example we have that the left adjoint functor is equivalently the pushout product functor with the initial morphism of XX:

X×()(X)(). X \times (-) \simeq (\emptyset \to X) \Box (-) \,.

By assumption (X)(\emptyset \to X) is a cofibration, and hence prop. says that this is a left Quillen functor.

The statement and proof of prop. has a direct analogue in pointed topological spaces

Proposition

For X(Top cg */) QuillenX \in (Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen} cofibrant with respect to the classical model structure on pointed compactly generated topological spaces (theorem , prop. ) (hence a retract of a cell complex with non-degenerate basepoint, remark ) then the pointed product-hom-adjunction from corollary is a Quillen adjunction (def. ):

(Top cg */) QuillenMaps(X,) *X()(Top cg */) Quillen. (Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen} \underoverset \underset{Maps(X,-)_\ast}{\longrightarrow} \overset{X \wedge (-)}{\longleftarrow} {\bot} (Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen} \,.
Proof

Let now \Box_\wedge denote the smash pushout product and () ()(-)^{\Box(-)} the smash pullback powering defined as in def. and def. , but with Cartesian product replaced by smash product (def. ) and compactly generated mapping space replaced by pointed mapping spaces (def. ).

By theorem (Top cg */) Quillen(Top_{cg}^{\ast/})_{Quillen} is cofibrantly generated by I Top */=(I Top) +I_{Top^{\ast/}} = (I_{Top})_+ and J Top */=(J Top) +J_{Top^{\ast/}}= (J_{Top})_+. Example gives that for i nI Topi_n \in I_{Top} and j nJ Topj_n \in J_{Top} then

(i n 1) + (i n 2) +(i n 1+n 2) + (i_{n_1})_+ \Box_\wedge (i_{n_2})_+ \simeq (i_{n_1 + n_2})_+

and

(i n 1) + (i n 2) +(i n 1+n 2) +. (i_{n_1})_+ \wedge_\wedge (i_{n_2})_+ \simeq (i_{n_1 + n_2})_+ \,.

Hence the pointed analog of prop. holds and therefore so does the pointed analog of the conclusion in prop. .

Model structure on topological functors

With classical topological homotopy theory in hand (theorem , theorem ), it is straightforward now to generalize this to a homotopy theory of topological diagrams. This is going to be the basis for the stable homotopy theory of spectra, because spectra may be identified with certain topological diagrams (prop.).

Technically, “topological diagram” here means “Top-enriched functor”. We now discuss what this means and then observe that as an immediate corollary of theorem we obtain a model category structure on topological diagrams.

As a by-product, we obtain the model category theory of homotopy colimits in topological spaces, which will be useful.

In the following we say Top-enriched category and Top-enriched functor etc. for what often is referred to as “topological category” and “topological functor” etc. As discussed there, these latter terms are ambiguous.

Literature (Riehl, chapter 3) for basics of enriched category theory; (Piacenza 91) for the projective model structure on topological functors.

\,

Definition

A topologically enriched category 𝒞\mathcal{C} is a Top cgTop_{cg}-enriched category, hence:

  1. a class Obj(𝒞)Obj(\mathcal{C}), called the class of objects;

  2. for each a,bObj(𝒞)a, b\in Obj(\mathcal{C}) a compactly generated topological space (def. )

    𝒞(a,b)Top cg, \mathcal{C}(a,b)\in Top_{cg} \,,

    called the space of morphisms or the hom-space between aa and bb;

  3. for each a,b,cObj(𝒞)a,b,c\in Obj(\mathcal{C}) a continuous function

    a,b,c:𝒞(a,b)×𝒞(b,c)𝒞(a,c) \circ_{a,b,c} \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}(a,b)\times \mathcal{C}(b,c) \longrightarrow \mathcal{C}(a,c)

    out of the cartesian product (by cor. : the image under kk of the product topological space), called the composition operation;

  4. for each aObj(𝒞)a \in Obj(\mathcal{C}) a point Id a𝒞(a,a)Id_a\in \mathcal{C}(a,a), called the identity morphism on aa

such that the composition is associative and unital.

Similarly a pointed topologically enriched category is such a structure with Top cgTop_{cg} replaced by Top cg */Top^{\ast/}_{cg} (def. ) and with the Cartesian product replaced by the smash product (def. ) of pointed topological spaces.

Remark

Given a (pointed) topologically enriched category as in def. , then forgetting the topology on the hom-spaces (along the forgetful functor U:Top cgSetU \colon Top_{cg} \to Set) yields an ordinary locally small category with

Hom 𝒞(a,b)=U(𝒞(a,b)). Hom_{\mathcal{C}}(a,b) = U(\mathcal{C}(a,b)) \,.

It is in this sense that 𝒞\mathcal{C} is a category with extra structure, and hence “enriched”.

The archetypical example is Top cgTop_{cg} itself:

Example

The category Top cgTop_{cg} (def. ) canonically obtains the structure of a topologically enriched category, def. , with hom-spaces given by the compactly generated mapping spaces (def. )

Top cg(X,Y)Y X Top_{cg}(X,Y) \coloneqq Y^X

and with composition

Y X×Z YZ X Y^X \times Z^Y \longrightarrow Z^X

given by the adjunct under the (product\dashv mapping-space)-adjunction from prop. of the evaluation morphisms

X×Y X×Z Y(ev,id)Y×Z YevZ. X \times Y^X \times Z^Y \overset{(ev, id)}{\longrightarrow} Y \times Z^Y \overset{ev}{\longrightarrow} Z \,.

Similarly, pointed compactly generated topological spaces Top k */Top_k^{\ast/} form a pointed topologically enriched category, using the pointed mapping spaces from example :

Top cg */(X,Y)Maps(X,Y) *. Top^{\ast/}_{cg}(X,Y) \coloneqq Maps(X,Y)_\ast \,.
Definition

A topologically enriched functor between two topologically enriched categories

F:𝒞𝒟 F \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow \mathcal{D}

is a Top cgTop_{cg}-enriched functor, hence:

  1. a function

    F 0:Obj(𝒞)Obj(𝒟) F_0 \;\colon\; Obj(\mathcal{C}) \longrightarrow Obj(\mathcal{D})

    of objects;

  2. for each a,bObj(𝒞)a,b \in Obj(\mathcal{C}) a continuous function

    F a,b:𝒞(a,b)𝒟(F 0(a),F 0(b)) F_{a,b} \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}(a,b) \longrightarrow \mathcal{D}(F_0(a), F_0(b))

    of hom-spaces,

such that this preserves composition and identity morphisms in the evident sense.

A homomorphism of topologically enriched functors

η:FG \eta \;\colon\; F \Rightarrow G

is a Top cgTop_{cg}-enriched natural transformation: for each cObj(𝒞)c \in Obj(\mathcal{C}) a choice of morphism η c𝒟(F(c),G(c))\eta_c \in \mathcal{D}(F(c),G(c)) such that for each pair of objects c,d𝒞c,d \in \mathcal{C} the two continuous functions

η dF():𝒞(c,d)𝒟(F(c),G(d)) \eta_d \circ F(-) \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}(c,d) \longrightarrow \mathcal{D}(F(c), G(d))

and

G()η c:𝒞(c,d)𝒟(F(c),G(d)) G(-) \circ \eta_c \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}(c,d) \longrightarrow \mathcal{D}(F(c), G(d))

agree.

We write [𝒞,𝒟][\mathcal{C}, \mathcal{D}] for the resulting category of topologically enriched functors.

Remark

The condition on an enriched natural transformation in def. is just that on an ordinary natural transformation on the underlying unenriched functors, saying that for every morphisms f:cdf \colon c \to d there is a commuting square

f𝒞(c,c)×X η c F(c) 𝒞(c,f) F(f) 𝒞(c,d)×X η d F(d). f \;\;\;\; \mapsto \;\;\;\; \array{ \mathcal{C}(c,c) \times X &\overset{\eta_c}{\longrightarrow}& F(c) \\ {}^{\mathllap{\mathcal{C}(c,f)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{F(f)}} \\ \mathcal{C}(c,d) \times X &\underset{\eta_d}{\longrightarrow}& F(d) } \,.
Example

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} any topologically enriched category, def. then a topologically enriched functor (def. )

F:𝒞Top cg F \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \longrightarrow Top_{cg}

to the archetypical topologically enriched category from example may be thought of as a topologically enriched copresheaf, at least if 𝒞\mathcal{C} is small (in that its class of objects is a proper set).

Hence the category of topologically enriched functors

[𝒞,Top cg] [\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}]

according to def. may be thought of as the (co-)presheaf category over 𝒞\mathcal{C} in the realm of topological enriched categories.

A functor F[𝒞,Top cg]F \in [\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}] is equivalently

  1. a compactly generated topological space F aTop cgF_a \in Top_{cg} for each object aObj(𝒞)a \in Obj(\mathcal{C});

  2. a continuous function

    F a×𝒞(a,b)F b F_a \times \mathcal{C}(a,b) \longrightarrow F_b

    for all pairs of objects a,bObj(𝒞)a,b \in Obj(\mathcal{C})

such that composition is respected, in the evident sense.

For every object c𝒞c \in \mathcal{C}, there is a topologically enriched representable functor, denoted y(c)y(c) or 𝒞(c,)\mathcal{C}(c,-) which sends objects to

y(c)(d)=𝒞(c,d)Top cg y(c)(d) = \mathcal{C}(c,d) \in Top_{cg}

and whose action on morphisms is, under the above identification, just the composition operation in 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

Proposition

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} any small topologically enriched category, def. then the enriched functor category [𝒞,Top cg][\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}] from example has all limits and colimits, and they are computed objectwise:

if

F :I[𝒞,Top cg] F_\bullet \;\colon\; I \longrightarrow [\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}]

is a diagram of functors and c𝒞c\in \mathcal{C} is any object, then

(lim iF i)(c)lim i(F i(c))Top cg (\underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i F_i)(c) \simeq \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i (F_i(c)) \;\;\in Top_{cg}

and

(lim iF i)(c)lim i(F i(c))Top cg. (\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_i F_i)(c) \simeq \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_i (F_i(c)) \;\; \in Top_{cg} \,.
Proof

First consider the underlying diagram of functors F i F_i^\circ where the topology on the hom-spaces of 𝒞\mathcal{C} and of Top cgTop_{cg} has been forgotten. Then one finds

(lim iF i )(c)lim i(F i (c))Set (\underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i F^\circ_i)(c) \simeq \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i (F^\circ_i(c)) \;\;\in Set

and

(lim iF i )(c)lim i(F i (c))Set (\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_i F^\circ _i)(c) \simeq \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_i (F^\circ_i(c)) \;\; \in Set

by the universal property of limits and colimits. (Given a morphism of diagrams then a unique compatible morphism between their limits or colimits, respectively, is induced as the universal factorization of the morphism of diagrams regarded as a cone or cocone, respectvely, over the codomain or domain diagram, respectively).

Hence it only remains to see that equipped with topology, these limits and colimits in SetSet become limits and colimits in Top cgTop_{cg}. That is just the statement of prop. with corollary .

Definition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a topologically enriched category, def. , with [𝒞,Top cg][\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}] its category of topologically enriched copresheaves from example .

  1. Define a functor

    ()():[𝒞,Top cg]×Top cg[𝒞,Top cg] (-)\cdot(-) \;\colon\; [\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}] \times Top_{cg} \longrightarrow [\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}]

    by forming objectwise cartesian products (hence kk of product topological spaces)

    FX:cF(c)×X. F \cdot X \;\colon\; c \mapsto F(c) \times X \,.

    This is called the tensoring of [𝒞,Top cg][\mathcal{C},Top_{cg}] over Top cgTop_{cg}.

  2. Define a functor

    () ():(Top cg) op×[𝒞,Top cg][𝒞,Top cg] (-)^{(-)} \;\colon\; (Top_{cg})^{op} \times [\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}] \longrightarrow [\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}]

    by forming objectwise compactly generated mapping spaces (def. )

    F X:cF(c) X. F^X \;\colon\; c \mapsto F(c)^X \,.

    This is called the powering of [𝒞,Top cg][\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}] over Top cgTop_{cg}.

Analogously, for 𝒞\mathcal{C} a pointed topologically enriched category, def. , with [𝒞,Top cg */][\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}^{\ast/}] its category of pointed topologically enriched copresheaves from example , then:

  1. Define a functor

    ()():[𝒞,Top cg */]×Top cg */[𝒞,Top cg */] (-)\wedge(-) \;\colon\; [\mathcal{C}, Top^{\ast/}_{cg}] \times Top^{\ast/}_{cg} \longrightarrow [\mathcal{C}, Top^{\ast/}_{cg}]

    by forming objectwise smash products (def. )

    FX:cF(c)X. F \wedge X \;\colon\; c \mapsto F(c) \wedge X \,.

    This is called the smash tensoring of [𝒞,Top cg */][\mathcal{C},Top^{\ast/}_{cg}] over Top cg */Top^{\ast/}_{cg}.

  2. Define a functor

    Maps(,) *:Top cg */×[𝒞,Top cg */][𝒞,Top cg */] Maps(-,-)_\ast \;\colon\; Top^{\ast/}_{cg} \times [\mathcal{C}, Top^{\ast/}_{cg}] \longrightarrow [\mathcal{C}, Top^{\ast/}_{cg}]

    by forming objectwise pointed mapping spaces (example )

    F X:cMaps(X,F(c)) *. F^X \;\colon\; c \mapsto Maps(X,F(c))_\ast \,.

    This is called the pointed powering of [𝒞,Top cg][\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}] over Top cgTop_{cg}.

There is a full blown Top cgTop_{cg}-enriched Yoneda lemma. The following records a slightly simplified version which is all that is needed here:

Proposition

(topologically enriched Yoneda-lemma)

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a topologically enriched category, def. , write [𝒞,Top cg][\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}] for its category of topologically enriched (co-)presheaves, and for cObj(𝒞)c\in Obj(\mathcal{C}) write y(c)=𝒞(c,)[𝒞,Top k]y(c) = \mathcal{C}(c,-) \in [\mathcal{C}, Top_k] for the topologically enriched functor that it represents, all according to example . Recall the tensoring operation (F,X)FX(F,X) \mapsto F \cdot X from def. .

For cObj(𝒞)c\in Obj(\mathcal{C}), XTop cgX \in Top_{cg} and F[𝒞,Top cg]F \in [\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}], there is a natural bijection between

  1. morphisms y(c)XFy(c) \cdot X \longrightarrow F in [𝒞,Top cg][\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}];

  2. morphisms XF(c)X \longrightarrow F(c) in Top cgTop_{cg}.

In short:

y(c)XFXF(c) \frac{ y(c)\cdot X \longrightarrow F }{ X \longrightarrow F(c) }
Proof

Given a morphism η:y(c)XF\eta \colon y(c) \cdot X \longrightarrow F consider its component

η c:𝒞(c,c)×XF(c) \eta_c \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}(c,c)\times X \longrightarrow F(c)

and restrict that to the identity morphism id c𝒞(c,c)id_c \in \mathcal{C}(c,c) in the first argument

η c(id c,):XF(c). \eta_c(id_c,-) \;\colon\; X \longrightarrow F(c) \,.

We claim that just this η c(id c,)\eta_c(id_c,-) already uniquely determines all components

η d:𝒞(c,d)×XF(d) \eta_d \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}(c,d)\times X \longrightarrow F(d)

of η\eta, for all dObj(𝒞)d \in Obj(\mathcal{C}): By definition of the transformation η\eta (def. ), the two functions

F()η c:𝒞(c,d)F(d) 𝒞(c,c)×X F(-) \circ \eta_c \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}(c,d) \longrightarrow F(d)^{\mathcal{C}(c,c) \times X}

and

η d𝒞(c,)×X:𝒞(c,d)F(d) 𝒞(c,c)×X \eta_d \circ \mathcal{C}(c,-) \times X \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}(c,d) \longrightarrow F(d)^{\mathcal{C}(c,c) \times X}

agree. This means (remark ) that they may be thought of jointly as a function with values in commuting squares in Top cgTop_{cg} of this form:

f𝒞(c,c)×X η c F(c) 𝒞(c,f) F(f) 𝒞(c,d)×X η d F(d) f \;\;\;\; \mapsto \;\;\;\; \array{ \mathcal{C}(c,c) \times X &\overset{\eta_c}{\longrightarrow}& F(c) \\ {}^{\mathllap{\mathcal{C}(c,f)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{F(f)}} \\ \mathcal{C}(c,d) \times X &\underset{\eta_d}{\longrightarrow}& F(d) }

For any f𝒞(c,d)f \in \mathcal{C}(c,d), consider the restriction of

η d𝒞(c,f)F(d) 𝒞(c,c)×X \eta_d \circ \mathcal{C}(c,f) \in F(d)^{\mathcal{C}(c,c) \times X}

to id c𝒞(c,c)id_c \in \mathcal{C}(c,c), hence restricting the above commuting squares to

f{id c}×X η c F(c) 𝒞(c,f) F(f) {f}×X η d F(d) f \;\;\;\; \mapsto \;\;\;\; \array{ \{id_c\} \times X &\overset{\eta_c}{\longrightarrow}& F(c) \\ {}^{\mathllap{\mathcal{C}(c,f)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{F(f)}} \\ \{f\} \times X &\underset{\eta_d}{\longrightarrow}& F(d) }

This shows that η d\eta_d is fixed to be the function

η d(f,x)=F(f)η c(id c,x) \eta_d(f,x) = F(f)\circ \eta_c(id_c,x)

and this is a continuous function since all the operations it is built from are continuous.

Conversely, given a continuous function α:XF(c)\alpha \colon X \longrightarrow F(c), define for each dd the function

η d:(f,x)F(f)α. \eta_d \colon (f,x) \mapsto F(f) \circ \alpha \,.

Running the above analysis backwards shows that this determines a transformation η:y(c)×XF\eta \colon y(c)\times X \to F.

Definition

For 𝒞\mathcal{C} a small topologically enriched category, def. , write

I Top 𝒞{y(c)(S n1ι nD n)} n,cObj(𝒞) I_{Top}^{\mathcal{C}} \;\coloneqq\; \left\{ y(c)\cdot (S^{n-1} \overset{\iota_n}{\longrightarrow} D^n) \right\}_{{n \in \mathbb{N},} \atop {c \in Obj(\mathcal{C})}}

and

J Top 𝒞{y(c)(D n(id,δ 0)D n×I)} n,cObj(𝒞) J_{Top}^{\mathcal{C}} \;\coloneqq\; \left\{ y(c)\cdot (D^n \overset{(id, \delta_0)}{\longrightarrow} D^n \times I) \right\}_{{n \in \mathbb{N},} \atop {c \in Obj(\mathcal{C})}}

for the sets of morphisms given by tensoring (def. ) the representable functors (example ) with the generating cofibrations (def.) and acyclic generating cofibrations (def. ), respectively, of (Top cg) Quillen(Top_{cg})_{Quillen} (theorem ).

These are going to be called the generating cofibrations and acyclic generating cofibrations for the projective model structure on topologically enriched functors over 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

Analogously, for 𝒞\mathcal{C} a pointed topologically-enriched category, write

I Top */ 𝒞{y(c)(S + n1(ι n) +D + n)} n,cObj(𝒞) I_{Top^{\ast/}}^{\mathcal{C}} \;\coloneqq\; \left\{ y(c) \wedge (S^{n-1}_+ \overset{(\iota_n)_+}{\longrightarrow} D^n_+) \right\}_{{n \in \mathbb{N},} \atop {c \in Obj(\mathcal{C})}}

and

J Top */ 𝒞{y(c)(D + n(id,δ 0) +(D n×I) +)} n,cObj(𝒞) J_{Top^{\ast/}}^{\mathcal{C}} \;\coloneqq\; \left\{ y(c) \wedge (D^n_+ \overset{(id, \delta_0)_+}{\longrightarrow} (D^n \times I)_+) \right\}_{{n \in \mathbb{N},} \atop {c \in Obj(\mathcal{C})}}

for the analogous construction applied to the pointed generating (acyclic) cofibrations of def. .

Definition

Given a small (pointed) topologically enriched category 𝒞\mathcal{C}, def. , say that a morphism in the category of (pointed) topologically enriched copresheaves [𝒞,Top cg][\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}] ([𝒞,Top cg */][\mathcal{C},Top_{cg}^{\ast/}]), example , hence a natural transformation between topologically enriched functors, η:FG\eta \colon F \to G is

  • a projective weak equivalence, if for all cObj(𝒞)c\in Obj(\mathcal{C}) the component η c:F(c)G(c)\eta_c \colon F(c) \to G(c) is a weak homotopy equivalence (def. );

  • a projective fibration if for all cObj(𝒞)c\in Obj(\mathcal{C}) the component η c:F(c)G(c)\eta_c \colon F(c) \to G(c) is a Serre fibration (def. );

  • a projective cofibration if it is a retract (rmk. ) of an I Top 𝒞I_{Top}^{\mathcal{C}}-relative cell complex (def. , def. ).

Write

[𝒞,(Top cg) Quillen] proj [\mathcal{C}, (Top_{cg})_{Quillen}]_{proj}

and

[𝒞,(Top cg */) Quillen] proj [\mathcal{C}, (Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen}]_{proj}

for the categories of topologically enriched functors equipped with these classes of morphisms.

Theorem

The classes of morphisms in def. constitute a model category structure on [𝒞,Top cg][\mathcal{C}, Top_{cg}] and [𝒞,Top cg */][\mathcal{C}, Top^{\ast/}_{cg}], called the projective model structure on enriched functors

[𝒞,(Top cg) Quillen] proj [\mathcal{C}, (Top_{cg})_{Quillen}]_{proj}

and

[𝒞,(Top cg */) Quillen] proj [\mathcal{C}, (Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen}]_{proj}

These are cofibrantly generated model category, def. , with set of generating (acyclic) cofibrations the sets I Top 𝒞I_{Top}^{\mathcal{C}}, J Top 𝒞J_{Top}^{\mathcal{C}} and I Top */ 𝒞I_{Top^{\ast/}}^{\mathcal{C}}, J Top */ 𝒞J_{Top^{\ast/}}^{\mathcal{C}} from def. , respectively.

(Piacenza 91, theorem 5.4)

Proof

By prop. the category has all limits and colimits, hence it remains to check the model structure.

But via the enriched Yoneda lemma (prop. ) it follows that proving the model structure reduces objectwise to the proof of theorem , theorem . In particular, the technical lemmas , and generalize immediately to the present situation, with the evident small change of wording:

For instance, the fact that a morphism of topologically enriched functors η:FG\eta \colon F \to G that has the right lifting property against the elements of I Top 𝒞I_{Top}^{\mathcal{C}} is a projective weak equivalence, follows by noticing that for fixed η:FG\eta \colon F \to G the enriched Yoneda lemma prop. gives a natural bijection of commuting diagrams (and their fillers) of the form

(y(c)S n1 F (idι n) η y(c)D n G)(S n1 F(c) η c D n G(c)), \left( \;\;\; \array{ y(c) \cdot S^{n-1} &\longrightarrow& F \\ {}^{\mathllap{(id\cdot \iota_n)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\eta}} \\ y(c) \cdot D^n &\longrightarrow& G } \;\;\; \right) \;\;\;\;\;\leftrightarrow\;\;\;\;\; \left( \;\;\; \array{ S^{n-1} &\longrightarrow& F(c) \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\eta_c}} \\ D^n &\longrightarrow& G(c) } \;\;\; \right) \,,

and hence the statement follows with part (A) of the proof of lemma .

With these three lemmas in hand, the remaining formal part of the proof goes through verbatim as above: repeatedly use the small object argument (prop. ) and the retract argument (prop. ) to establish the two weak factorization systems. (While again the structure of a category with weak equivalences is evident.)

Example

Given examples and , the next evident example of a pointed topologically enriched category besides Top cg */Top^{\ast/}_{cg} itself is the functor category

[Top cg */,Top cg */]. [Top_{cg}^{\ast/}, Top_{cg}^{\ast/}] \,.

The only technical problem with this is that Top cg */Top^{\ast/}_{cg} is not a small category (it has a proper class of objects), which means that the existence of all limits and colimits via prop. may (and does) fail.

But so we just restrict to a small topologically enriched subcategory. A good choice is the full subcategory

Top cg,fin */Top cg */ Top^{\ast/}_{cg,fin} \hookrightarrow Top^{\ast/}_{cg}

of topological spaces homoemorphic to finite CW-complexes. The resulting projective model category (via theorem )

[Top cg,fin */,(Top cg */) Quillen] proj [Top_{cg,fin}^{\ast/}\;,\; (Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen}]_{proj}

is also also known as the strict model structure for excisive functors. (This terminology is the special case for n=1n = 1 of the terminology “n-excisive functors” as used in “Goodwillie calculus”, a homotopy-theoretic analog of differential calculus.) After enlarging its class of weak equivalences while keeping the cofibrations fixed, this will become Quillen equivalent to a model structure for spectra. This we discuss in part 1.2, in the section on pre-excisive functors.

One consequence of theorem is the model category theoretic incarnation of the theory of homotopy colimits.

Observe that ordinary limits and colimits (def. ) are equivalently characterized in terms of adjoint functors:

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be any category and let II be a small category. Write [I,𝒞][I,\mathcal{C}] for the corresponding functor category. We may think of its objects as II-shaped diagrams in 𝒞\mathcal{C}, and of its morphisms as homomorphisms of these diagrams. There is a canonical functor

const I:𝒞[I,𝒞] const_I \;\colon\; \mathcal{C} \overset{}{\longrightarrow} [I,\mathcal{C}]

which sends each object of 𝒞\mathcal{C} to the diagram that is constant on this object. Inspection of the definition of the universal properties of limits and colimits on one hand, and of left adjoint and right adjoint functors on the other hand, shows that

  1. precisely when 𝒞\mathcal{C} has all colimits of shape II, then the functor const Iconst_I has a left adjoint functor, which is the operation of forming these colimits:

    [I,𝒞]const Ilim I𝒞 [I,\mathcal{C}] \underoverset {\underset{const_I}{\longleftarrow}} {\overset{\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_I}{\longrightarrow}} {\bot} \mathcal{C}
  2. precisely when 𝒞\mathcal{C} has all limits of shape II, then the functor const Iconst_I has a right adjoint functor, which is the operation of forming these limits.

    [I,𝒞]lim Iconst I𝒞 [I,\mathcal{C}] \underoverset {\underset{\underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_I}{\longrightarrow}} {\overset{const_I}{\longleftarrow}} {\bot} \mathcal{C}
Proposition

Let II be a small topologically enriched category (def. ). Then the (lim Iconst I)(\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_I \dashv const_I)-adjunction

[I,(Top cg) Quillen] projconst Ilim I(Top cg) Quillen [I,(Top_{cg})_{Quillen}]_{proj} \underoverset {\underset{const_I}{\longleftarrow}} {\overset{\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_I}{\longrightarrow}} {\bot} (Top_{cg})_{Quillen}

is a Quillen adjunction (def. ) between the projective model structure on topological functors on II, from theorem , and the classical model structure on topological spaces from theorem .

Similarly, if II is enriched in pointed topological spaces, then for the classical model structure on pointed topological spaces (prop. , theorem ) the adjunction

[I,(Top cg */) Quillen] projconstlim(Top cg */) Quillen [I,(Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen}]_{proj} \underoverset {\underset{const}{\longleftarrow}} {\overset{\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}}{\longrightarrow}} {\bot} (Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen}

is a Quillen adjunction.

Proof

Since the fibrations and weak equivalences in the projective model structure (def. ) on the functor category are objectwise those of (Top cg) Quillen(Top_{cg})_{Quillen} and of (Top cg */) Quillen(Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen}, respectively, it is immediate that the functor const Iconst_I preserves these. In particular it preserves fibrations and acyclic fibrations and so the claim follows (prop. ).

Definition

In the situation of prop. we say that the left derived functor (def. ) of the colimit functor is the homotopy colimit

hocolim I𝕃lim I:Ho([I,Top])Ho(Top) hocolim_I \coloneqq \mathbb{L}\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_I \;\colon\; Ho([I,Top]) \longrightarrow Ho(Top)

and

hocolim I𝕃lim I:Ho([I,Top */])Ho(Top */). hocolim_I \coloneqq \mathbb{L}\underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_I \;\colon\; Ho([I,Top^{\ast/}]) \longrightarrow Ho(Top^{\ast/}) \,.
Remark

Since every object in (Top cg) Quillen(Top_{cg})_{Quillen} and in (Top cg */) Quillen(Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen} is fibrant, the homotopy colimit of any diagram X X_\bullet, according to def. , is (up to weak homotopy equivalence) the result of forming the ordinary colimit of any projectively cofibrant replacement X^ W projX \hat X_\bullet \overset{\in W_{proj}}{\to} X_\bullet.

Example

Write \mathbb{N}^{\leq} for the poset (def. ) of natural numbers, hence for the small category (with at most one morphism from any given object to any other given object) that looks like

={0123}. \mathbb{N}^{\leq} = \left\{ 0 \to 1 \to 2 \to 3 \to \cdots \right\} \,.

Regard this as a topologically enriched category with the, necessarily, discrete topology on its hom-sets.

Then a topologically enriched functor

X : Top cg X_\bullet \;\colon\; \mathbb{N}^{\leq} \longrightarrow Top_{cg}

is just a plain functor and is equivalently a sequence of continuous functions (morphisms in Top cgTop_{cg}) of the form (also called a cotower)

X 0f 0X 1f 1X 2f 2X 3. X_0 \overset{f_0}{\longrightarrow} X_1 \overset{f_1}{\longrightarrow} X_2 \overset{f_2}{\longrightarrow} X_3 \longrightarrow \cdots \,.

It is immediate to check that those sequences X X_\bullet which are cofibrant in the projective model structure (theorem ) are precisely those for which

  1. all component morphisms f if_i are cofibrations in (Top cg) Quillen(Top_{cg})_{Quillen} or (Top cg */) Quillen(Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen}, respectively, hence retracts (remark ) of relative cell complex inclusions (def. );

  2. the object X 0X_0, and hence all other objects, are cofibrant, hence are retracts of cell complexes (def. ).

By example it is immediate that the operation of forming colimits sends projective (acyclic) cofibrations between sequences of topological spaces to (acyclic) cofibrations in the classical model structure on pointed topological spaces. On those projectively cofibrant sequences where every map is not just a retract of a relative cell complex inclusion, but a plain relative cell complex inclusion, more is true:

Proposition

In the projective model structures on cotowers in topological spaces, [ ,(Top cg) Quillen] proj[\mathbb{N}^{\leq}, (Top_{cg})_{Quillen}]_{proj} and [ ,(Top cg */) Quillen] proj[\mathbb{N}^{\leq}, (Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen}]_{proj} from def. , the following holds:

  1. The colimit functor preserves fibrations between sequences of relative cell complex inclusions;

  2. Let II be a finite category, let D ():I[ ,Top cg]D_\bullet(-) \colon I \to [\mathbb{N}^{\leq}, Top_{cg}] be a finite diagram of sequences of relative cell complexes. Then there is a weak homotopy equivalence

    lim n(lim iD n(i))W cllim i(lim nD n(i)) \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_{n} \left( \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i D_n(i) \right) \overset{\in W_{cl}}{\longrightarrow} \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i \left( \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_{n} D_n(i) \right)

    from the colimit over the limit sequnce to the limit of the colimits of sequences.

Proof

Regarding the first statement:

Use that both (Top cg) Quillen(Top_{cg})_{Quillen} and (Top cg */) Quillen(Top^{\ast/}_{cg})_{Quillen} are cofibrantly generated model categories (theorem ) whose generating acyclic cofibrations have compact topological spaces as domains and codomains. The colimit over a sequence of relative cell complexes (being a transfinite composition) yields another relative cell complex, and hence lemma says that every morphism out of the domain or codomain of a generating acyclic cofibration into this colimit factors through a finite stage inclusion. Since a projective fibration is a degreewise fibration, we have the lifting property at that finite stage, and hence also the lifting property against the morphisms of colimits.

Regarding the second statement:

This is a model category theoretic version of a standard fact of plain category theory, which says that in the category Set of sets, filtered colimits commute with finite limits in that there is an isomorphism of sets of the form which we have to prove is a weak homotopy equivalence of topological spaces. But now using that weak homotopy equivalences are detected by forming homotopy groups (def. ), hence hom-sets out of n-spheres, and since nn-spheres are compact topological spaces, lemma says that homming out of nn-spheres commutes over the colimits in question. Moreover, generally homming out of anything commutes over limits, in particular finite limits (every hom functor is left exact functor in the second variable). Therefore we find isomorphisms of the form

Hom(S q,lim n(lim iD n(i)))lim n(lim iHom(S q,D n(i)))lim i(lim nHom(S qD n(i)))Hom(S q,lim i(lim nD n(i))) Hom\left( S^q, \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_{n} \left( \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i D_n(i) \right) \right) \simeq \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_{n} \left( \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i Hom\left(S^q, D_n(i)\right) \right) \overset{\sim}{\longrightarrow} \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i \left( \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_{n} Hom\left(S^q D_n(i)\right) \right) \simeq Hom\left( S^q, \underset{\longleftarrow}{\lim}_i \left( \underset{\longrightarrow}{\lim}_{n} D_n(i) \right) \right)

and similarly for the left homotopies Hom(S q×I,)Hom(S^q \times I,-) (and similarly for the pointed case). This implies the claimed isomorphism on homotopy groups.

Homotopy fiber sequences

A key aspect of homotopy theory is that the universal constructions of category theory, such as limits and colimits, receive a refinement whereby their universal properties hold not just up to isomorphism but up to (weak) homotopy equivalence. One speaks of homotopy limits and homotopy colimits.

We consider this here just for the special case of homotopy fibers and homotopy cofibers, leading to the phenomenon of homotopy fiber sequences and their induced long exact sequences of homotopy groups which control much of the theory to follow.

Mapping cones

In the context of homotopy theory, a pullback diagram, such as in the definition of the fiber in example

fib(f) X f * Y \array{ fib(f) &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Y }

ought to commute only up to a (left/right) homotopy (def. ) between the outer composite morphisms. Moreover, it should satisfy its universal property up to such homotopies.

Instead of going through the full theory of what this means, we observe that this is plausibly modeled by the following construction, and then we check (below) that this indeed has the relevant abstract homotopy theoretic properties.

Definition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category, def. with 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} its model structure on pointed objects, prop. . For f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y a morphism between cofibrant objects (hence a morphism in (𝒞 */) c𝒞 */(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/})_c\hookrightarrow \mathcal{C}^{\ast/}, def. ), its reduced mapping cone is the object

Cone(f)*XCyl(X)XY Cone(f) \coloneqq \ast \underset{X}{\sqcup} Cyl(X) \underset{X}{\sqcup} Y

in the colimiting diagram

X f Y i 1 i X i 0 Cyl(X) η * Cone(f), \array{ && X &\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{i_1}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{i}} \\ X &\stackrel{i_0}{\longrightarrow}& Cyl(X) \\ \downarrow && & \searrow^{\mathrlap{\eta}} & \downarrow \\ {*} &\longrightarrow& &\longrightarrow& Cone(f) } \,,

where Cyl(X)Cyl(X) is a cylinder object for XX, def. .

Dually, for f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y a morphism between fibrant objects (hence a morphism in (𝒞 *) f𝒞 */(\mathcal{C}^{\ast})_f\hookrightarrow \mathcal{C}^{\ast/}, def. ), its mapping cocone is the object

Path *(f)*×YPath(Y)×YY Path_\ast(f) \coloneqq \ast \underset{Y}{\times} Path(Y)\underset{Y}{\times} Y

in the following limit diagram

Path *(f) X η f Path(Y) p 1 Y p 0 * Y, \array{ Path_\ast(f) &\longrightarrow& &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow &\searrow^{\mathrlap{\eta}}& && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ && Path(Y) &\underset{p_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_0}} \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Y } \,,

where Path(Y)Path(Y) is a path space object for YY, def. .

Remark

When we write homotopies (def. ) as double arrows between morphisms, then the limit diagram in def. looks just like the square in the definition of fibers in example , except that it is filled by the right homotopy given by the component map denoted η\eta:

Path *(f) X η f * Y. \array{ Path_\ast(f) &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow &\swArrow_{\eta}& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.

Dually, the colimiting diagram for the mapping cone turns to look just like the square for the cofiber, except that it is filled with a left homotopy

X f Y η * Cone(f) \array{ X &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ \downarrow &\swArrow_{\eta}& \downarrow \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Cone(f) }
Proposition

The colimit appearing in the definition of the reduced mapping cone in def. is equivalent to three consecutive pushouts:

X f Y i 1 (po) i X i 0 Cyl(X) Cyl(f) (po) (po) * Cone(X) Cone(f). \array{ && X &\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{i_1}} &(po)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{i}} \\ X &\stackrel{i_0}{\longrightarrow}& Cyl(X) &\longrightarrow& Cyl(f) \\ \downarrow &(po)& \downarrow & (po) & \downarrow \\ {*} &\longrightarrow& Cone(X) &\longrightarrow& Cone(f) } \,.

The two intermediate objects appearing here are called

  • the plain reduced cone Cone(X)*XCyl(X)Cone(X) \coloneqq \ast \underset{X}{\sqcup} Cyl(X);

  • the reduced mapping cylinder Cyl(f)Cyl(X)XYCyl(f) \coloneqq Cyl(X) \underset{X}{\sqcup} Y.

Dually, the limit appearing in the definition of the mapping cocone in def. is equivalent to three consecutive pullbacks:

Path *(f) Path(f) X (pb) (pb) f Path *(Y) Path(Y) p 1 Y (pb) p 0 * Y. \array{ Path_\ast(f) &\longrightarrow& Path(f) &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ Path_\ast(Y) &\longrightarrow& Path(Y) &\underset{p_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_0}} \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.

The two intermediate objects appearing here are called

  • the based path space object Path *(Y)*YPath(Y)Path_\ast(Y) \coloneqq \ast \underset{Y}{\prod} Path(Y);

  • the mapping path space or mapping co-cylinder Path(f)X×YPath(X)Path(f) \coloneqq X \underset{Y}{\times} Path(X).

Definition

Let X𝒞 */X \in \mathcal{C}^{\ast/} be any pointed object.

  1. The mapping cone, def. , of X*X \to \ast is called the reduced suspension of XX, denoted

    ΣX=Cone(X*). \Sigma X = Cone(X\to\ast)\,.

    Via prop. this is equivalently the coproduct of two copies of the cone on XX over their base:

    X * i 1 (po) X i 0 Cyl(X) Cone(X) (po) (po) * Cone(X) ΣX. \array{ && X &\stackrel{}{\longrightarrow}& \ast \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{i_1}} &(po)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{}} \\ X &\stackrel{i_0}{\longrightarrow}& Cyl(X) &\longrightarrow& Cone(X) \\ \downarrow &(po)& \downarrow & (po) & \downarrow \\ {*} &\longrightarrow& Cone(X) &\longrightarrow& \Sigma X } \,.

    This is also equivalently the cofiber, example of (i 0,i 1)(i_0,i_1), hence (example ) of the wedge sum inclusion:

    XX=XX(i 0,i 1)Cyl(X)cofib(i 0,i 1)ΣX. X \vee X = X \sqcup X \overset{(i_0,i_1)}{\longrightarrow} Cyl(X) \overset{cofib(i_0,i_1)}{\longrightarrow} \Sigma X \,.
  2. The mapping cocone, def. , of *X\ast \to X is called the loop space object of XX, denoted

    ΩX=Path *(*X). \Omega X = Path_\ast(\ast \to X) \,.

    Via prop. this is equivalently

    ΩX Path *(X) * (pb) (pb) Path *(X) Path(X) p 1 X (pb) p 0 * X. \array{ \Omega X &\longrightarrow& Path_\ast(X) &\longrightarrow& \ast \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{} \\ Path_\ast(X) &\longrightarrow& Path(X) &\underset{p_1}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_0}} \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& X } \,.

    This is also equivalently the fiber, example of (p 0,p 1)(p_0,p_1):

    ΩXfib(p 0,p 1)Path(X)(p 0,p 1)X×X. \Omega X \overset{fib(p_0,p_1)}{\longrightarrow} Path(X) \overset{(p_0,p_1)}{\longrightarrow} X \times X \,.
Proposition

In pointed topological spaces Top */Top^{\ast/},

  • the reduced suspension objects (def. ) induced from the standard reduced cylinder ()(I +)(-)\wedge (I_+) of example are isomorphic to the smash product (def. ) with the 1-sphere, for later purposes we choose to smash on the left and write

    cofib(XXX(I +))S 1X, cofib(X \vee X \to X \wedge (I_+)) \simeq S^1 \wedge X \,,

Dually:

  • the loop space objects (def. ) induced from the standard pointed path space object Maps(I +,) *Maps(I_+,-)_\ast are isomorphic to the pointed mapping space (example ) with the 1-sphere

    fib(Maps(I +,X) *X×X)Maps(S 1,X) *. fib(Maps(I_+,X)_\ast \to X \times X) \simeq Maps(S^1, X)_\ast \,.
Proof

By immediate inspection: For instance the fiber of Maps(I +,X) *X×XMaps(I_+,X)_\ast \longrightarrow X\times X is clearly the subspace of the unpointed mapping space X IX^I on elements that take the endpoints of II to the basepoint of XX.

Example

For 𝒞=\mathcal{C} = Top with Cyl(X)=X×ICyl(X) = X\times I the standard cyclinder object, def. , then by example , the mapping cone, def. , of a continuous function f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y is obtained by

  1. forming the cylinder over XX;

  2. attaching to one end of that cylinder the space YY as specified by the map ff.

  3. shrinking the other end of the cylinder to the point.

Accordingly the suspension of a topological space is the result of shrinking both ends of the cylinder on the object two the point. This is homeomoprhic to attaching two copies of the cone on the space at the base of the cone.

(graphics taken from Muro 2010)

Below in example we find the homotopy-theoretic interpretation of this standard topological mapping cone as a model for the homotopy cofiber.

Remark

The formula for the mapping cone in prop. (as opposed to that of the mapping co-cone) does not require the presence of the basepoint: for f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y a morphism in 𝒞\mathcal{C} (as opposed to in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) we may still define

Cone(f)YXCone(X), Cone'(f) \coloneqq Y \underset{X}{\sqcup} Cone'(X) \,,

where the prime denotes the unreduced cone, formed from a cylinder object in 𝒞\mathcal{C}.

Proposition

For f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y a morphism in Top, then its unreduced mapping cone, remark , with respect to the standard cylinder object X×IX \times I def. , is isomorphic to the reduced mapping cone, def. , of the morphism f +:X +Y +f_+ \colon X_+ \to Y_+ (with a basepoint adjoined, def. ) with respect to the standard reduced cylinder (example ):

Cone(f)Cone(f +). Cone'(f) \simeq Cone(f_+) \,.
Proof

By prop. and example , Cone(f +)Cone(f_+) is given by the colimit in TopTop over the following diagram:

* X* (f,id) Y* X* (X×I)* * Cone(f +). \array{ \ast &\longrightarrow& X \sqcup \ast &\overset{(f,id)}{\longrightarrow}& Y \sqcup \ast \\ \downarrow && \downarrow && \downarrow \\ X \sqcup\ast &\longrightarrow& (X \times I) \sqcup \ast \\ \downarrow && && \downarrow \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& &\longrightarrow& Cone(f_+) } \,.

We may factor the vertical maps to give

* X* (f,id) Y* X* (X×I)* ** Cone(f) + * Cone(f). \array{ \ast &\longrightarrow& X \sqcup \ast &\overset{(f,id)}{\longrightarrow}& Y \sqcup \ast \\ \downarrow && \downarrow && \downarrow \\ X \sqcup\ast &\longrightarrow& (X \times I) \sqcup \ast \\ \downarrow && && \downarrow \\ \ast \sqcup \ast &\longrightarrow& &\longrightarrow& Cone'(f)_+ \\ \downarrow && && \downarrow \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& &\longrightarrow& Cone'(f) } \,.

This way the top part of the diagram (using the pasting law to compute the colimit in two stages) is manifestly a cocone under the result of applying () +(-)_+ to the diagram for the unreduced cone. Since () +(-)_+ is itself given by a colimit, it preserves colimits, and hence gives the partial colimit Cone(f) +Cone'(f)_+ as shown. The remaining pushout then contracts the remaining copy of the point away.

Example makes it clear that every cycle S nYS^n \to Y in YY that happens to be in the image of XX can be continuously translated in the cylinder-direction, keeping it constant in YY, to the other end of the cylinder, where it shrinks away to the point. This means that every homotopy group of YY, def. , in the image of ff vanishes in the mapping cone. Hence in the mapping cone the image of XX under ff in YY is removed up to homotopy. This makes it intuitively clear how Cone(f)Cone(f) is a homotopy-version of the cokernel of ff. We now discuss this formally.

Lemma

(factorization lemma)

Let 𝒞 c\mathcal{C}_c be a category of cofibrant objects, def. . Then for every morphism f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y the mapping cylinder-construction in def. provides a cofibration resolution of ff, in that

  1. the composite morphism Xi 0Cyl(X)(i 1) *fCyl(f)X \overset{i_0}{\longrightarrow} Cyl(X) \overset{(i_1)_\ast f}{\longrightarrow} Cyl(f) is a cofibration;

  2. ff factors through this morphism by a weak equivalence left inverse to an acyclic cofibration

    f:XCof(i 1) *fi 0Cyl(f)WY, f \;\colon\; X \underoverset{\in Cof}{(i_1)_\ast f\circ i_0}{\longrightarrow} Cyl(f) \underset{\in W}{\longrightarrow} Y \,,

Dually:

Let 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f be a category of fibrant objects, def. . Then for every morphism f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y the mapping cocylinder-construction in def. provides a fibration resolution of ff, in that

  1. the composite morphism Path(f)p 1 *fPath(Y)p 0YPath(f) \overset{p_1^\ast f}{\longrightarrow} Path(Y) \overset{p_0}{\longrightarrow} Y is a fibration;

  2. ff factors through this morphism by a weak equivalence right inverse to an acyclic fibration:

    f:XWPath(f)Fibp 0p 1 *fY, f \;\colon\; X \underset{\in W}{\longrightarrow} Path(f) \underoverset{\in Fib}{p_0 \circ p_1^\ast f}{\longrightarrow} Y \,,
Proof

We discuss the second case. The first case is formally dual.

So consider the mapping cocylinder-construction from prop.

(1)Path(f) WFib X p 1 *f (pb) f Path(Y) WFibp 1 Y WFib p 0 Y. \array{ Path(f) &\overset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{p_1^\ast f}}\downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ Path(Y) &\underoverset{\in W \cap Fib}{p_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in W \cap Fib}}\downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_0}} \\ Y } \,.

To see that the vertical composite is indeed a fibration, notice that, by the pasting law, the above pullback diagram may be decomposed as a pasting of two pullback diagram as follows

Path(f) Fib(f,id) *(p 1,p 0) X×Y pr 1 X (f,Id) f Path(Y) (p 1,p 0)Fib Y×Y pr 1 Y p 0 pr 2Fib Y. \array{ Path(f) &\underoverset{\in Fib}{(f,id)^\ast(p_1,p_0)}{\longrightarrow}& X \times Y &\stackrel{pr_1}{\to}& X \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(f, Id)}} && \downarrow^\mathrlap{f} \\ Path(Y) &\overset{(p_1,p_0) \in Fib }{\longrightarrow}& Y \times Y &\stackrel{pr_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{p_0}}\downarrow & \swarrow_{\mathrlap{pr_2 \atop {\in Fib}}} \\ Y } \,.

Both squares are pullback squares. Since pullbacks of fibrations are fibrations by prop. , the morphism Path(f)X×YPath(f) \to X \times Y is a fibration. Similarly, since XX is fibrant, also the projection map X×YYX \times Y \to Y is a fibration (being the pullback of X*X \to \ast along Y*Y \to \ast).

Since the vertical composite is thereby exhibited as the composite of two fibrations

Path(f)(f,id) *(p 1,p 0)X×Ypr 2(f,Id)=pr 2Y, Path(f) \overset{(f,id)^\ast(p_1,p_0)}{\longrightarrow} X \times Y \stackrel{pr_2 \circ (f ,Id) = pr_2}{\longrightarrow} Y \,,

it is itself a fibration.

Then to see that there is a weak equivalence as claimed:

The universal property of the pullback Path(f)Path(f) induces a right inverse of Path(f)XPath(f) \to X fitting into this diagram

id X: X W Path(f) WFib X f f id Y: Y Wi Path(Y) p 1 Y Id p 0 Y, \array{ id_X \colon & X &\underoverset{\in W}{\exists}{\longrightarrow} & Path(f) & \overset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ & {}^{\mathrlap{f}}\downarrow && \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ id_Y\colon& Y &\underoverset{\in W}{i}{\longrightarrow}& Path(Y) &\stackrel{p_1}{\to}& Y \\ & & {}_{\mathllap{Id}}\searrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_0}} \\ & && Y } \,,

which is a weak equivalence, as indicated, by two-out-of-three (def. ).

This establishes the claim.

Categories of fibrant objects

Below we discuss the homotopy-theoretic properties of the mapping cone- and mapping cocone-constructions from above. Before we do so, we here establish a collection of general facts that hold in categories of fibrant objects and dually in categories of cofibrant objects, def. .

Literature (Brown 73, section 4).

Lemma

Let f:XYf\colon X \longrightarrow Y be a morphism in a category of fibrant objects, def. . Then given any choice of path space objects Path(X)Path(X) and Path(Y)Path(Y), def. , there is a replacement of Path(X)Path(X) by a path space object Path(X)˜\widetilde{Path(X)} along an acylic fibration, such that Path(X)˜\widetilde{Path(X)} has a morphism ϕ\phi to Path(Y)Path(Y) which is compatible with the structure maps, in that the following diagram commutes

X f Y Path(X) WFib Path(X)˜ ϕ Path(Y) (p 0 X,p 1 X) (p˜ 0 X,p˜ 1 X) (p 0 Y,p 1 Y) X×X (f,f) Y×Y. \array{ && X &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ &\swarrow& \downarrow && \downarrow \\ Path(X) &\underset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longleftarrow}& \widetilde{Path(X)} &\overset{\phi}{\longrightarrow}& Path(Y) \\ &{}_{\mathllap{(p^X_0,p^X_1)}}\searrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(\tilde p^X_0,\tilde p^X_1)}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(p^Y_0,p^Y_1)}} \\ && X \times X &\overset{(f,f)}{\longrightarrow}& Y \times Y } \,.

(Brown 73, section 2, lemma 2)

Proof

Consider the commuting square

X f Y Path(Y) (p 0 Y,p 1 Y) Path(X) (p 0 X,p 1 X) X×X (f,f) Y×Y. \array{ X &\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y &\longrightarrow& Path(Y) \\ \downarrow && && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(p_0^Y, p_1^Y)}} \\ Path(X) &\overset{(p^X_0,p^X_1)}{\longrightarrow}& X \times X &\overset{(f,f)}{\longrightarrow}& Y \times Y } \,.

Then consider its factorization through the pullback of the right morphism along the bottom morphism,

X (fp 0 X,fp 1 X) *Path(Y) Path(Y) W Fib Fib (p 0 Y,p 1 Y) Path(X) (fp 0 X,fp 1 X) Y×Y. \array{ X &\longrightarrow& (f \circ p_0^X, f\circ p_1^X)^\ast Path(Y) &\longrightarrow& Path(Y) \\ &{}_{\mathllap{\in W}}\searrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(p_0^Y, p_1^Y)}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ && Path(X) &\overset{(f \circ p_0^X, f\circ p_1^X)}{\longrightarrow}& Y \times Y } \,.

Finally use the factorization lemma to factor the morphism X(fp 0 X,fp 1 X) *Path(Y)X \to (f \circ p_0^X, f\circ p_1^X)^\ast Path(Y) through a weak equivalence followed by a fibration, the object this factors through serves as the desired path space resolution

X W Path(X)˜ Path(Y) W WFib (p 0 Y,p 1 Y) Path(X) (fp 0 X,fp 1 X) Y×Y. \array{ X &\overset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& \widetilde{Path(X)} &\longrightarrow& Path(Y) \\ &{}_{\mathllap{\in W}}\searrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Fib}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(p_0^Y, p_1^Y)}} \\ && Path(X) &\overset{(f \circ p_0^X, f\circ p_1^X)}{\longrightarrow}& Y \times Y } \,.
Lemma

In a category of fibrant objects 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f, def. , let

A 1 f A 2 Fib Fib B \array{ A_1 &&\stackrel{f}{\longrightarrow}&& A_2 \\ & {}_{\in Fib}\searrow && \swarrow_{\in Fib} \\ && B }

be a morphism over some object BB in 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f and let u:BBu \colon B' \to B be any morphism in 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f. Let

u *A 1 u *f u *A 2 Fib Fib B \array{ u^*A_1 &&\stackrel{u^* f}{\longrightarrow}&& u^* A_2 \\ & {}_{\in Fib}\searrow && \swarrow_{\in Fib} \\ && B' }

be the corresponding morphism pulled back along uu.

Then

  • if ff is a fibration then also u *fu^* f is a fibration;

  • if ff is a weak equivalence then also u *fu^* f is a weak equivalence.

(Brown 73, section 4, lemma 1)

Proof

For fFibf \in Fib the statement follows from the pasting law which says that if in

B× BA 1 A 1 u *fFib fFib B× BA 2 A 2 Fib Fib B u B \array{ B' \times_B A_1 &\longrightarrow& A_1 \\ \;\;\downarrow^{\mathrlap{u^* f \in Fib}} && \;\;\downarrow^{\mathrlap{f \in Fib}} \\ B' \times_B A_2 &\longrightarrow& A_2 \\ \;\downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} && \;\downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ B' &\stackrel{u}{\longrightarrow}& B }

the bottom and the total square are pullback squares, then so is the top square. The same reasoning applies for fWFibf \in W \cap Fib.

Now to see the case that fWf\in W:

Consider the full subcategory (𝒞 /B) f(\mathcal{C}_{/B})_f of the slice category 𝒞 /B\mathcal{C}_{/B} (def. ) on its fibrant objects, i.e. the full subcategory of the slice category on the fibrations

X Fib p B \array{ X \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ B }

into BB. By factorizing for every such fibration the diagonal morphisms into the fiber product X×BXX \underset{B}{\times} X through a weak equivalence followed by a fibration, we obtain path space objects Path B(X)Path_B(X) relative to BB:

(Δ X)/B: X W Path B(X) Fib X×BX Fib Fib B. \array{ (\Delta_X)/B \;\colon & X &\overset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& Path_B(X) &\overset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow}& X \underset{B}{\times} X \\ & & {}_{\mathllap{\in Fib}}\searrow & \downarrow & \swarrow_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ & && B } \,.

With these, the factorization lemma (lemma ) applies in (𝒞 /B) f(\mathcal{C}_{/B})_f.

(Notice that for this we do need the restriction of 𝒞 /B\mathcal{C}_{/B} to the fibrations, because this ensures that the projections p i:X 1× BX 2X ip_i \colon X_1 \times_B X_2 \to X_i are still fibrations, which is used in the proof of the factorization lemma (here).)

So now given any

X Wf Y Fib Fib B \array{ X && \underoverset{\in W}{f}{\longrightarrow} && Y \\ & {}_{\mathllap{\in Fib}}\searrow && \swarrow_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ && B }

apply the factorization lemma in (𝒞 /B) f(\mathcal{C}_{/B})_f to factor it as

X iW Path B(f) WFib Y Fib Fib B. \array{ X &\overset{i \in W}{\longrightarrow}& Path_B(f) &\overset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ & {}_{\mathllap{\in Fib}}\searrow &\downarrow& \swarrow_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ && B } \,.

By the previous discussion it is sufficient now to show that the base change of ii to BB' is still a weak equivalence. But by the factorization lemma in (𝒞 /B) f(\mathcal{C}_{/B})_f, the morphism ii is right inverse to another acyclic fibration over BB:

id X: X iW Path B(f) WFib X Fib Fib B. \array{ id_X \;\colon & X &\overset{i \in W}{\longrightarrow}& Path_B(f) &\overset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ & & {}_{\mathllap{\in Fib}}\searrow &\downarrow& \swarrow_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ & && B } \,.

(Notice that if we had applied the factorization lemma just for Δ X\Delta_X in 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f instead of for (Δ X)/B(\Delta_X)/B in (𝒞 /B)(\mathcal{C}_{/B}) then the corresponding triangle on the right would not be guaranteed commute.)

Now we may reason as before: the base change of the top morphism here is exhibited by the following pasting composite of pullbacks:

B×BX X (pb) B×BPath B(f) Path B(f) (pb) WFib B×BX X (pb) B B. \array{ B' \underset{B}{\times} X &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow \\ B' \underset{B}{\times} Path_B(f) &\longrightarrow& Path_B(f) \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Fib}} \\ B' \underset{B}{\times}X &\longrightarrow& X \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow \\ B' &\longrightarrow& B } \,.

The acyclic fibration Path B(f)Path_B(f) is preserved by this pullback, as is the identity id X:XPath B(X)Xid_X \colon X \to Path_B(X)\to X. Hence the weak equivalence XPath B(X)X \to Path_B(X) is preserved by two-out-of-three (def. ).

Remark

Lemma implies in particular that in a category 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f of fibrant objects, the operation of fiber product

A× B():𝒞 f/B𝒞 f/B A \times_B (-) \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}_f/B \longrightarrow \mathcal{C}_f/B

with a fibration ABA \to B preserves fibrations and weak equivalences between fibrations. For B=*B = \ast the terminal objects this means that the plain Cartesian product

A×():𝒞 f𝒞 f A \times (-) \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}_f \longrightarrow \mathcal{C}_f

preserves fibrations and weak equivalences (cf. Brown 73, p. 431).

Lemma

In a category of fibrant objects, def. , the pullback of a weak equivalence along a fibration is again a weak equivalence.

(Brown 73, section 4, lemma 2)

Proof

Let u:BBu \colon B' \to B be a weak equivalence and p:EB p \colon E \to B be a fibration. We want to show that the left vertical morphism in the pullback

E× BB B W W E Fib B \array{ E \times_B B' &\longrightarrow& B' \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\Rightarrow \in W} } && \;\downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} \\ E &\stackrel{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow}& B }

is a weak equivalence.

First of all, using the factorization lemma we may factor BBB' \to B as

BWPath(u)WFB B' \stackrel{\in W}{\longrightarrow} Path(u) \stackrel{\in W \cap F}{\longrightarrow} B

with the first morphism a weak equivalence that is a right inverse to an acyclic fibration and the right one an acyclic fibration.

Then the pullback diagram in question may be decomposed into two consecutive pullback diagrams

E× BB B Q Fib Path(u) WFib WFib E Fib B, \array{ E \times_B B' &\to& B' \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ Q &\stackrel{\in Fib}{\to}& Path(u) \\ \;\;\downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Fib}} && \;\;\downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W \cap Fib}} \\ E &\stackrel{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow}& B } \,,

where the morphisms are indicated as fibrations and acyclic fibrations using the stability of these under arbitrary pullback.

This means that the proof reduces to proving that weak equivalences u:BWBu : B' \stackrel{\in W}{\to} B that are right inverse to some acyclic fibration v:BWFBv : B \stackrel{\in W \cap F}{\to} B' map to a weak equivalence under pullback along a fibration.

Given such uu with right inverse vv, consider the pullback diagram

E (p,id)W id E 1 B× BE WFib E Fib pFib (pb) B vWFib B vFibW B. \array{ & E \\ & {}^{\mathllap{{(p,id)}\atop \in W}}\downarrow & \searrow^{\mathrlap{id}} \\ E_1 \coloneqq & B \times_{B'} E & \stackrel{\in W \cap Fib }{\longrightarrow} & E \\ & \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p \in Fib }} \\ & &(pb)& B \\ & \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{v \in W \cap Fib}} \\ & B &\overset{v \in Fib \cap W}{\longrightarrow}& B' } \,.

Notice that the indicated universal morphism p×Id:EWE 1p \times Id \colon E \stackrel{\in W}{\to} E_1 into the pullback is a weak equivalence by two-out-of-three (def. ).

The previous lemma says that weak equivalences between fibrations over BB are themselves preserved by base extension along u:BBu \colon B' \to B. In total this yields the following diagram

u *E=B× BE E u *(p×Id)W p×IdW id u *E 1 E 1 WFib E Fib Fib pFib B vWFib B u B vWFib B \array{ && u^* E = B' \times_B E &\longrightarrow & E \\ && {}^{\mathllap{ {u^*(p \times Id)} \atop {\in W} }}\downarrow && {}^{\mathllap{ {p \times Id} \atop {\in W} }}\downarrow & \searrow^{\mathrlap{id}} \\ && u^* E_1 &\longrightarrow& E_1 &\stackrel{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow}& E \\ &&\downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}}&&\downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p \in Fib}} \\ &&&&&& B \\ &&\downarrow&&\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{v \in W \cap Fib}} \\ && B' &\stackrel{u}{\longrightarrow}& B &\stackrel{v \in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow}& B' }

so that with p×Id:EE 1p \times Id : E \to E_1 a weak equivalence also u *(p×Id)u^* (p \times Id) is a weak equivalence, as indicated.

Notice that u *E=B× BEEu^* E = B' \times_B E \to E is the morphism that we want to show is a weak equivalence. By two-out-of-three (def. ) for that it is now sufficient to show that u *E 1E 1u^* E_1 \to E_1 is a weak equivalence.

That finally follows now since, by assumption, the total bottom horizontal morphism is the identity. Hence so is the top horizontal morphism. Therefore u *E 1E 1u^\ast E_1 \to E_1 is right inverse to a weak equivalence, hence is a weak equivalence.

Lemma

Let (𝒞 */) f(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/})_f be a category of fibrant objects, def. in a model structure on pointed objects (prop. ). Given any commuting diagram in 𝒞 \mathcal{C}^{} of the form

X 1 tW X 1 gf X 2 Fib p 1 Fib p 2 B u C \array{ X'_1 &\underoverset{t}{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& X_1 &\stackrel{\overset{f}{\longrightarrow}}{\underset{g}{\longrightarrow}}& X_2 \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_1}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p_2}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ && B &\overset{u}{\longrightarrow}& C }

(meaning: both squares commute and tt equalizes ff with gg) then the localization functor γ:(𝒞 */) fHo(𝒞 */)\gamma \colon (\mathcal{C}^{\ast/})_f \to Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) (def. , cor ) takes the morphisms fib(p 1)fib(p 2)fib(p_1) \stackrel{\longrightarrow}{\longrightarrow} fib(p_2) induced by ff and gg on fibers (example ) to the same morphism, in the homotopy category.

(Brown 73, section 4, lemma 4)

Proof

First consider the pullback of p 2p_2 along uu: this forms the same kind of diagram but with the bottom morphism an identity. Hence it is sufficient to consider this special case.

Consider the full subcategory (𝒞 /B */) f(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}_{/B})_f of the slice category 𝒞 /B */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}_{/B} (def. ) on its fibrant objects, i.e. the full subcategory of the slice category on the fibrations

X Fib p B \array{ X \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ B }

into BB. By factorizing for every such fibration the diagonal morphisms into the fiber product X×BXX \underset{B}{\times} X through a weak equivalence followed by a fibration, we obtain path space objects Path B(X)Path_B(X) relative to BB:

(Δ X)/B: X W Path B(X) Fib X×BX Fib Fib B. \array{ (\Delta_X)/B \;\colon & X &\overset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& Path_B(X) &\overset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow}& X \underset{B}{\times} X \\ & & {}_{\mathllap{\in Fib}}\searrow & \downarrow & \swarrow_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ & && B } \,.

With these, the factorization lemma (lemma ) applies in (𝒞 /B */) f(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}_{/B})_f.

Let then XsPath B(X 2)(p 0,p 1)X 2× BX 2X\overset{s}{\to}Path_B(X_2)\overset{(p_0,p_1)}{\to} X_2 \times_B X_2 be a path space object for X 2X_2 in the slice over BB and consider the following commuting square

X 1 sft Path B(X 2) W t Fib (p 0,p 1) X 1 (f,g) X 2×BX 2. \array{ X'_1 &\overset{s f t}{\longrightarrow}& Path_B(X_2) \\ {}^{\mathllap{t}}_{\mathllap{\in W}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(p_0,p_1)}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ X_1 &\overset{(f,g)}{\longrightarrow}& X_2\underset{B}{\times} X_2 } \,.

By factoring this through the pullback (f,g) *(p 0,p 1)(f,g)^\ast(p_0,p_1) and then applying the factorization lemma and then two-out-of-three (def. ) to the factoring morphisms, this may be replaced by a commuting square of the same form, where however the left morphism is an acyclic fibration

X 1 Path B(X 2) WFib t Fib (p 0,p 1) X 1 (f,g) X 2×BX 2. \array{ X''_1 &\overset{}{\longrightarrow}& Path_B(X_2) \\ {}^{\mathllap{t}}_{\mathllap{\in W\cap Fib}} \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{(p_0,p_1)}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ X_1 &\overset{(f,g)}{\longrightarrow}& X_2\underset{B}{\times} X_2 } \,.

This makes also the morphism X 1BX''_1 \to B be a fibration, so that the whole diagram may now be regarded as a diagram in the category of fibrant objects (𝒞 /B) f(\mathcal{C}_{/B})_f of the slice category over BB.

As such, the top horizontal morphism now exhibits a right homotopy which under localization γ B:(𝒞 /B) fHo(𝒞 /B)\gamma_B \;\colon\; (\mathcal{C}_{/B})_f \longrightarrow Ho(\mathcal{C}_{/B}) (def. ) of the slice model structure (prop. ) we have

γ B(f)=γ B(g). \gamma_B(f) = \gamma_B(g) \,.

The result then follows by observing that we have a commuting square of functors

(𝒞 /B */) f fib 𝒞 */ γ B γ Ho(𝒞 /B */) Ho(𝒞 */), \array{ (\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}_{/B})_f &\overset{fib}{\longrightarrow}& \mathcal{C}^{\ast/} \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma_B}} &\swArrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\gamma}} \\ Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}_{/B}) &\longrightarrow& Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) } \,,

because, by lemma , the top and right composite sends weak equivalences to isomorphisms, and hence the bottom filler exists by theorem . This implies the claim.

Homotopy fibers

We now discuss the homotopy-theoretic properties of the mapping cone- and mapping cocone-constructions from above.

Literature (Brown 73, section 4).

Remark

The factorization lemma with prop. says that the mapping cocone of a morphism ff, def. , is equivalently the plain fiber, example , of a fibrant resolution f˜\tilde f of ff:

Path *(f) Path(f) (pb) f˜ * Y. \array{ Path_\ast(f) &\longrightarrow& Path(f) \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\tilde f}} \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.

The following prop. says that, up to equivalence, this situation is independent of the specific fibration resolution f˜\tilde f provided by the factorization lemma (hence by the prescription for the mapping cocone), but only depends on it being some fibration resolution.

Proposition

In the category of fibrant objects (𝒞 */) f(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/})_f, def. , of a model structure on pointed objects (prop. ) consider a morphism of fiber-diagrams, hence a commuting diagram of the form

fib(p 1) X 1 Fibp 1 Y 1 h g f fib(p 2) X 2 Fibp 2 Y 2. \array{ fib(p_1) &\longrightarrow& X_1 &\underoverset{\in Fib}{p_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y_1 \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{h}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{g}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ fib(p_2) &\longrightarrow& X_2 &\underoverset{\in Fib}{p_2}{\longrightarrow}& Y_2 } \,.

If ff and gg weak equivalences, then so is hh.

Proof

Factor the diagram in question through the pullback of p 2p_2 along ff

fib(p 1) X 1 h W p 1 fib(f *p 2) f *X 2 Fibf *p 2 Y 1 W W f fib(p 2) X 2 Fibp 2 Y 2 \array{ fib(p_1) &\longrightarrow& X_1 \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{h}} && {}^{\mathllap{\in W}}\downarrow & \searrow^{\mathrlap{p_1}} & \\ fib(f^\ast p_2) &\longrightarrow& f^\ast X_2 &\underoverset{\in Fib}{f^\ast p_2}{\longrightarrow}& Y_1 \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\simeq}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}}_{\mathrlap{\in W}} \\ fib(p_2) &\longrightarrow& X_2 &\underoverset{\in Fib}{p_2}{\longrightarrow}& Y_2 }

and observe that

  1. fib(f *p 2)=pt *f *p 2=pt *p 2=fib(p 2)fib(f^\ast p_2) = pt^\ast f^\ast p_2 = pt^\ast p_2 = fib(p_2);

  2. f *X 2X 2f^\ast X_2 \to X_2 is a weak equivalence by lemma ;

  3. X 1f *X 2X_1 \to f^\ast X_2 is a weak equivalence by assumption and by two-out-of-three (def. );

Moreover, this diagram exhibits h:fib(p 1)fib(f *p 2)=fib(p 2)h \colon fib(p_1)\to fib(f^\ast p_2) = fib(p_2) as the base change, along *Y 1\ast \to Y_1, of X 1f *X 2X_1 \to f^\ast X_2. Therefore the claim now follows with lemma .

Hence we say:

Definition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category and 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} its model category of pointed objects, prop. . For f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y any morphism in its category of fibrant objects (𝒞 */) f(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/})_f, def. , then its homotopy fiber

hofib(f)X hofib(f)\longrightarrow X

is the morphism in the homotopy category Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}), def. , which is represented by the fiber, example , of any fibration resolution f˜\tilde f of ff (hence any fibration f˜\tilde f such that ff factors through a weak equivalence followed by f˜\tilde f).

Dually:

For f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y any morphism in its category of cofibrant objects (𝒞 */) c(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/})_c, def. , then its homotopy cofiber

Yhocofib(f) Y \longrightarrow hocofib(f)

is the morphism in the homotopy category Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}), def. , which is represented by the cofiber, example , of any cofibration resolution of ff (hence any cofibration f˜\tilde f such that ff factors as f˜\tilde f followed by a weak equivalence).

Proposition

The homotopy fiber in def. is indeed well defined, in that for f 1f_1 and f 2f_2 two fibration replacements of any morphisms ff in 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f, then their fibers are isomorphic in Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}).

Proof

It is sufficient to exhibit an isomorphism in Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) from the fiber of the fibration replacement given by the factorization lemma (for any choice of path space object) to the fiber of any other fibration resolution.

Hence given a morphism f:YXf \colon Y \longrightarrow X and a factorization

f:XWX^f 1FibY f \;\colon\; X \underset{\in W}{\longrightarrow} \hat X \underoverset{f_1}{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow} Y

consider, for any choice Path(Y)Path(Y) of path space object (def. ), the diagram

Path(f) WFib X W (pb) W Path(f 1) WFib X^ Fib (pb) f 1Fib Path(Y) WFibp 1 Y p 0WFib Y \array{ Path(f) &\overset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in W}}\downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} \\ Path(f_1) &\overset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow}& \hat X \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in Fib}}\downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{ {f_1} \atop {\in Fib}}} \\ Path(Y) &\underoverset{\in W \cap Fib}{p_1}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ {}^{\mathllap{ {p_0} \atop \in W \cap Fib}}\downarrow \\ Y }

as in the proof of lemma . Now by repeatedly using prop. :

  1. the bottom square gives a weak equivalence from the fiber of Path(f 1)Path(Y)Path(f_1) \to Path(Y) to the fiber of f 1f_1;

  2. The square

    Path(f 1) id Path(f 1) Path(Y) p 0 Y \array{ Path(f_1) &\overset{id}{\longrightarrow}& Path(f_1) \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ Path(Y) &\underset{p_0}{\longrightarrow}& Y }

    gives a weak equivalence from the fiber of Path(f 1)Path(Y)Path(f_1) \to Path(Y) to the fiber of Path(f 1)YPath(f_1)\to Y.

  3. Similarly the total vertical composite gives a weak equivalence via

    Path(f) W Path(f 1) Y id Y \array{ Path(f) &\overset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& Path(f_1) \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ Y &\underset{id}{\longrightarrow}& Y }

from the fiber of Path(f)YPath(f) \to Y to the fiber of Path(f 1)YPath(f_1)\to Y.

Together this is a zig-zag of weak equivalences of the form

fib(f 1)Wfib(Path(f 1)Path(Y))Wfib(Path(f 1)Y)Wfib(Path(f)Y) fib(f_1) \;\overset{\in W}{\longleftarrow}\; fib(Path(f_1)\to Path(Y)) \;\overset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}\; fib(Path(f_1)\to Y) \;\overset{\in W}{\longleftarrow}\; fib(Path(f) \to Y)

between the fiber of Path(f)YPath(f) \to Y and the fiber of f 1f_1. This gives an isomorphism in the homotopy category.

Example

(fibers of Serre fibrations)

In showing that Serre fibrations are abstract fibrations in the sense of model category theory, theorem implies that the fiber FF (example ) of a Serre fibration, def.

F X p B \array{ F &\longrightarrow& X \\ && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} \\ && B }

over any point is actually a homotopy fiber in the sense of def. . With prop. this implies that the weak homotopy type of the fiber only depends on the Serre fibration up to weak homotopy equivalence in that if p:XBp' \colon X' \to B' is another Serre fibration fitting into a commuting diagram of the form

X W cl X p p B W cl B \array{ X &\overset{\in W_{cl}}{\longrightarrow}& X' \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{p'}} \\ B &\overset{\in W_{cl}}{\longrightarrow}& B' }

then FW clFF \overset{\in W_{cl}}{\longrightarrow} F'.

In particular this gives that the weak homotopy type of the fiber of a Serre fibration p:XBp \colon X \to B does not change as the basepoint is moved in the same connected component. For let γ:IB\gamma \colon I \longrightarrow B be a path between two points

b 0,1:*W cli 0,1IγB. b_{0,1} \;\colon\; \ast \underoverset{\in W_{cl}}{i_{0,1}}{\longrightarrow} I \overset{\gamma}{\longrightarrow} B \,.

Then since all objects in (Top cg) Quillen(Top_{cg})_{Quillen} are fibrant, and since the endpoint inclusions i 0,1i_{0,1} are weak equivalences, lemma gives the zig-zag of top horizontal weak equivalences in the following diagram:

F b 0= b 0 *p W cl γ *p W cl b 1 *p =F b 1 (pb) γ *fFib (pb) * i 0W cl I i 1W cl * \array{ F_{b_0} = & b_0^\ast p &\overset{\in W_{cl}}{\longrightarrow}& \gamma^{\ast}p &\overset{\in W_{cl}}{\longleftarrow}& b_1^\ast p & = F_{b_1} \\ & \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow{\mathrlap{{\gamma^\ast f} \atop {\in \atop {Fib}}}} &\;\;(pb)& \downarrow \\ & \ast &\underoverset{i_0}{\in W_{cl}}{\longrightarrow}& I &\underoverset{i_1}{\in W_{cl}}{\longleftarrow}& \ast }

and hence an isomorphism F b 0F b 1F_{b_0} \simeq F_{b_1} in the classical homotopy category (def. ).

The same kind of argument applied to maps from the square I 2I^2 gives that if γ 1,γ 2:IB\gamma_1, \gamma_2\colon I \to B are two homotopic paths with coinciding endpoints, then the isomorphisms between fibers over endpoints which they induce are equal. (But in general the isomorphism between the fibers does depend on the choice of homotopy class of paths connecting the basepoints!)

The same kind of argument also shows that if BB has the structure of a cell complex (def. ) then the restriction of the Serre fibration to one cell D nD^n may be identified in the homotopy category with D n×FD^n \times F, and may be canonically identified so if the fundamental group of XX is trivial. This is used when deriving the Serre-Atiyah-Hirzebruch spectral sequence for pp (prop.).

Example

For every continuous function f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y between CW-complexes, def. , then the standard topological mapping cone is the attaching space (example )

Y fCone(X)Top Y \cup_f Cone(X) \;\; \in Top

of YY with the standard cone Cone(X)Cone(X) given by collapsing one end of the standard topological cyclinder X×IX \times I (def. ) as shown in example .

Equipped with the canonical continuous function

YY fCone(X) Y \longrightarrow Y \cup_f Cone(X)

this represents the homotopy cofiber, def. , of ff with respect to the classical model structure on topological spaces 𝒞=Top Quillen\mathcal{C}= Top_{Quillen} from theorem .

Proof

By prop. , for XX a CW-complex then the standard topological cylinder object X×IX\times I is indeed a cyclinder object in Top QuillenTop_{Quillen}. Therefore by prop. and the factorization lemma , the mapping cone construction indeed produces first a cofibrant replacement of ff and then the ordinary cofiber of that, hence a model for the homotopy cofiber.

Example

The homotopy fiber of the inclusion of classifying spaces BO(n)BO(n+1)B O(n) \hookrightarrow B O(n+1) is the n-sphere S nS^n. See this prop. at Classifying spaces and G-structure.

Example

Suppose a morphism f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y already happens to be a fibration between fibrant objects. The factorization lemma replaces it by a fibration out of the mapping cocylinder Path(f)Path(f), but such that the comparison morphism is a weak equivalence:

fib(f) X Fibf Y W W id fib(f˜) Path(f) Fibf˜ Y. \array{ fib(f) &\longrightarrow& X &\underoverset{\in Fib}{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{id}} \\ fib(\tilde f) &\longrightarrow& Path(f) &\underoverset{\in Fib}{\tilde f}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

Hence by prop. in this case the ordinary fiber of ff is weakly equivalent to the mapping cocone, def. .

We may now state the abstract version of the statement of prop. :

Proposition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category. For f:XYf \colon X \to Y any morphism of pointed objects, and for AA a pointed object, def. , then the sequence

[A,hofib(f)] *i *[A,X] *f *[A,Y] * [A,hofib(f)]_\ast \overset{i_\ast}{\longrightarrow} [A,X]_\ast \overset{f_\ast}{\longrightarrow} [A,Y]_{\ast}

is exact as a sequence of pointed sets.

(Where the sequence here is the image of the homotopy fiber sequence of def. under the hom-functor [A,] *:Ho(𝒞 */)Set */[A,-]_\ast \;\colon\; Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) \longrightarrow Set^{\ast/} from example .)

Proof

Let AA, XX and YY denote fibrant-cofibrant objects in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} representing the given objects of the same name in Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}). Moreover, let ff be a fibration in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} representing the given morphism of the same name in Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}).

Then by def. and prop. there is a representative hofib(f)𝒞hofib(f) \in \mathcal{C} of the homotopy fiber which fits into a pullback diagram of the form

hofib(f) i X f * Y \array{ hofib(f) &\overset{i}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Y }

With this the hom-sets in question are represented by genuine morphisms in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}, modulo homotopy. From this it follows immediately that im(i *)im(i_\ast) includes into ker(f *)ker(f_\ast). Hence it remains to show the converse: that every element in ker(f *)ker(f_\ast) indeed comes from im(i *)im(i_\ast).

But an element in ker(f *)ker(f_\ast) is represented by a morphism α:AX\alpha \colon A \to X such that there is a left homotopy as in the following diagram

A α X i 0 η˜ f A i 1 Cyl(A) η Y = * Y. \array{ && A &\overset{\alpha}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ && {}^{\mathllap{i_0}}\downarrow &{}^{\tilde \eta}\nearrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ A &\overset{i_1}{\longrightarrow} & Cyl(A) &\overset{\eta}{\longrightarrow}& Y \\ \downarrow && && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{=}} \\ \ast && \longrightarrow && Y } \,.

Now by lemma the square here has a lift η˜\tilde \eta, as shown. This means that i 1η˜i_1 \circ\tilde \eta is left homotopic to α\alpha. But by the universal property of the fiber, i 1η˜i_1 \circ \tilde \eta factors through i:hofib(f)Xi \colon hofib(f) \to X.

With prop. it also follows notably that the loop space construction becomes well-defined on the homotopy category:

Remark

Given an object X𝒞 f */X \in \mathcal{C}^{\ast/}_f, and picking any path space object Path(X)Path(X), def. with induced loop space object ΩX\Omega X, def. , write Path 2(X)=Path(X)×XPath(X)Path_2(X) = Path(X) \underset{X}{\times} Path(X) for the path space object given by the fiber product of Path(X)Path(X) with itself, via example . From the pullback diagram there, the fiber inclusion ΩXPath(X)\Omega X \to Path(X) induces a morphism

ΩX×ΩX(ΩX) 2. \Omega X \times \Omega X \longrightarrow (\Omega X)_2 \,.

In the case where 𝒞 */=Top */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} = Top^{\ast/} and Ω\Omega is induced, via def. , from the standard path space object (def. ), i.e. in the case that

ΩX=fib(Maps(I +,X) *X×X), \Omega X = fib(Maps(I_+,X)_\ast \longrightarrow X \times X) \,,

then this is the operation of concatenating two loops parameterized by I=[0,1]I = [0,1] to a single loop parameterized by [0,2][0,2].

Proposition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category, def. . Then the construction of forming loop space objects XΩXX\mapsto \Omega X, def. (which on 𝒞 f */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}_f depends on a choice of path space objects, def. ) becomes unique up to isomorphism in the homotopy category (def. ) of the model structure on pointed objects (prop. ) and extends to a functor:

Ω:Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(𝒞 */). \Omega \;\colon\; Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) \longrightarrow Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) \,.

Dually, the reduced suspension operation, def. , which on 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} depends on a choice of cylinder object, becomes a functor on the homotopy category

Σ:Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(𝒞 */). \Sigma \;\colon\; Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) \longrightarrow Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) \,.

Moreover, the pairing operation induced on the objects in the image of this functor via remark (concatenation of loops) gives the objects in the image of Ω\Omega group object structure, and makes this functor lift as

Ω:Ho(𝒞 */)Grp(Ho(𝒞 */)). \Omega \;\colon\; Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) \longrightarrow Grp(Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/})) \,.

(Brown 73, section 4, theorem 3)

Proof

Given an object X𝒞 */X \in \mathcal{C}^{\ast/} and given two choices of path space objects Path(X)Path(X) and Path(X)˜\widetilde{Path(X)}, we need to produce an isomorphism in Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) between ΩX\Omega X and Ω˜X\tilde \Omega X.

To that end, first lemma implies that any two choices of path space objects are connected via a third path space by a span of morphisms compatible with the structure maps. By two-out-of-three (def. ) every morphism of path space objects compatible with the inclusion of the base object is a weak equivalence. With this, lemma implies that these morphisms induce weak equivalences on the corresponding loop space objects. This shows that all choices of loop space objects become isomorphic in the homotopy category.

Moreover, all the isomorphisms produced this way are actually equal: this follows from lemma applied to

X s Path(X) Path(X)˜ X×X id X×X. \array{ X &\overset{s}{\longrightarrow}& Path(X) &\stackrel{\longrightarrow}{\longrightarrow}& \widetilde{Path(X)} \\ && \downarrow && \downarrow \\ && X\times X &\overset{id}{\longrightarrow}& X \times X } \,.

This way we obtain a functor

Ω:𝒞 f */Ho(𝒞 */). \Omega \;\colon\; \mathcal{C}^{\ast/}_f \longrightarrow Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) \,.

By prop. and Rem. this functor sends weak equivalences to isomorphisms. Therefore the functor on homotopy categories now follows with theorem .

It is immediate to see that the operation of loop concatenation from remark gives the objects ΩXHo(𝒞 */)\Omega X \in Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) the structure of monoids. It is now sufficient to see that these are in fact groups:

We claim that the inverse-assigning operation is given by the left map in the following pasting composite

ΩX Path(X) X×X (pb) swap ΩX Path(X) (p 0,p 1) X×X, \array{ \Omega' X &\longrightarrow& Path'(X) &\overset{}{\longrightarrow}& X \times X \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\simeq}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\simeq}} &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{swap}} \\ \Omega X &\longrightarrow& Path(X) &\underset{(p_0,p_1)}{\longrightarrow}& X \times X } \,,

(where Path(X)Path'(X), thus defined, is the path space object obtained from Path(X)Path(X) by “reversing the notion of source and target of a path”).

To see that this is indeed an inverse, it is sufficient to see that the two morphisms

ΩX(ΩX) 2 \Omega X \stackrel{\longrightarrow}{\longrightarrow} (\Omega X)_2

induced from

Path(X)(sp 0,sp 0)ΔPath(X)× XPath(X) \array{ Path(X) \stackrel{\overset{\Delta}{\longrightarrow}}{\underset{(s\circ p_0,s \circ p_0)}{\longrightarrow}} Path(X) \times_X Path'(X) }

coincide in the homotopy category. This follows with lemma applied to the following commuting diagram:

X i Path(X) (sp 0,sp 0)Δ Path(X)× XPath(X) (p 0,p 1) X×X Δpr 1 X×X. \array{ X &\overset{i}{\longrightarrow}& Path(X) &\stackrel{\overset{\Delta}{\longrightarrow}}{\underset{(s\circ p_0,s \circ p_0)}{\longrightarrow}}& Path(X)\times_X Path'(X) \\ && {}^{\mathllap{(p_0,p_1)}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{}} \\ && X\times X &\overset{\Delta \circ pr_1}{\longrightarrow}& X \times X } \,.

Homotopy pullbacks

The concept of homotopy fibers of def. is a special case of the more general concept of homotopy pullbacks.

Definition

A model category 𝒞\mathcal{C} (def. ) is called a right proper model category if pullback along fibrations preserves weak equivalences.

Example

By lemma , a model category 𝒞\mathcal{C} (def. ) in which all objects are fibrant is a right proper model category (def. ).

Definition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a right proper model category (def. ). Then a commuting square

A B g C f D \array{ A &\longrightarrow& B \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{g}} \\ C &\underset{f}{\longrightarrow}& D }

in 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f is called a homotopy pullback (of ff along gg and equivalently of gg along ff) if the following equivalent conditions hold:

  1. for some factorization of the form

    g:BWB^FibD g \colon B \overset{\in W }{\longrightarrow} \hat B \overset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow} D

    the universally induced morphism from AA into the pullback of B^\hat B along ff is a weak equivalence:

    A B W W C×DB^ B^ (pb) Fib C D. \array{ A &\longrightarrow& B \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in W}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} \\ C \underset{D}{\times} \hat B &\longrightarrow& \hat B \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ C &\longrightarrow& D } \,.
  2. for some factorization of the form

    f:CWC^FibD f \colon C \overset{\in W }{\longrightarrow} \hat C \overset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow} D

    the universally induced morphism from AA into the pullback of D^\hat D along gg is a weak equivalence:

    AWC^×DB. A \overset{\in W}{\longrightarrow} \hat C \underset{D}{\times} B \,.
  3. the above two conditions hold for every such factorization.

(e.g. Goerss-Jardine 96, II (8.14))

Proposition

The conditions in def. are indeed equivalent.

Proof

First assume that the first condition holds, in that

A B W W C×DB^ B^ (pb) Fib C D. \array{ A &\longrightarrow& B \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in W}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} \\ C \underset{D}{\times} \hat B &\longrightarrow& \hat B \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ C &\longrightarrow& D } \,.

Then let

f:CWC^FibD f \colon C \overset{\in W }{\longrightarrow} \hat C \overset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow} D

be any factorization of ff and consider the pasting diagram (using the pasting law for pullbacks)

A C^×DB B W W (pb) W C×DB^ W C^×DD^ Fib B^ (pb) Fib (pb) Fib C W C^ Fib D, \array{ A &\overset{}{\longrightarrow}& \hat C \underset{D}{\times} B &\longrightarrow& B \\ {}^{\mathllap{\in W}}\downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} \\ C\underset{D}{\times} \hat B &\overset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& \hat C \underset{D}{\times} \hat D &\overset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow}& \hat B \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in \atop Fib}} &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ C &\underset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& \hat C &\underset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow}& D } \,,

where the inner morphisms are fibrations and weak equivalences, as shown, by the pullback stability of fibrations (prop. ) and then since pullback along fibrations preserves weak equivalences by assumption of right properness (def. ). Hence it follows by two-out-of-three (def. ) that also the comparison morphism AC^×DBA \to \hat C \underset{D}{\times} B is a weak equivalence.

In conclusion, if the homotopy pullback condition is satisfied for one factorization of gg, then it is satisfied for all factorizations of ff. Since the argument is symmetric in ff and gg, this proves the claim.

Remark

In particular, an ordinary pullback square of fibrant objects, one of whose edges is a fibration, is a homotopy pullback square according to def. .

Proposition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a right proper model category (def. ). Given a diagram in 𝒞\mathcal{C} of the form

A B Fib C W W W D E Fib F \array{ A &\longrightarrow& B &\overset{\in Fib}{\longleftarrow}& C \\ \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} \\ D &\longrightarrow& E &\underset{\in Fib}{\longleftarrow}& F }

then the induced morphism on pullbacks is a weak equivalence

A×BCWD×EF. A \underset{B}{\times} C \overset{\in W}{\longrightarrow} D \underset{E}{\times} F \,.
Proof

(The reader should draw the 3-dimensional cube diagram which we describe in words now.)

First consider the universal morphism CE×FCC \to E \underset{F}{\times} C and observe that it is a weak equivalence by right properness (def. ) and two-out-of-three (def. ).

Then consider the universal morphism A×BCA×B(E×FC)A \underset{B}{\times}C \to A \underset{B}{\times}(E \underset{F}{\times}C) and observe that this is also a weak equivalence, since A×BCA \underset{B}{\times} C is the limiting cone of a homotopy pullback square by remark , and since the morphism is the comparison morphism to the pullback of the factorization constructed in the first step.

Now by using the pasting law, then the commutativity of the “left” face of the cube, then the pasting law again, one finds that A×B(E×FC)A×D(DFE×)A \underset{B}{\times} (E \underset{F}{\times} C) \simeq A \underset{D}{\times} (D \underset{E} F{\times}). Again by right properness this implies that A×B(E×FC)D×EFA \underset{B}{\times} (E \underset{F}{\times} C)\to D \underset{E}{\times} F is a weak equivalence.

With this the claim follows by two-out-of-three.

Homotopy pullbacks satisfy the usual abstract properties of pullbacks:

Proposition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a right proper model category (def. ). If in a commuting square in 𝒞\mathcal{C} one edge is a weak equivalence, then the square is a homotopy pullback square precisely if the opposite edge is a weak equivalence, too.

Proof

Consider a commuting square of the form

A B C W D. \array{ A &\longrightarrow& B \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ C &\underset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& D } \,.

To detect whether this is a homotopy pullback, by def. and prop. , we are to choose any factorization of the right vertical morphism to obtain the pasting composite

A B W C×DB^ W B^ (pb) Fib C W D. \array{ A &\longrightarrow& B \\ \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in W}} \\ C \underset{D}{\times} \hat B &\overset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& \hat B \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ C &\underset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& D } \,.

Here the morphism in the middle is a weak equivalence by right properness (def. ). Hence it follows by two-out-of-three that the top left comparison morphism is a weak equivalence (and so the original square is a homotopy pullback) precisely if the top morphism is a weak equivalence.

Proposition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a right proper model category (def. ).

  1. (pasting law) If in a commuting diagram

    A B C D E F \array{ A &\longrightarrow& B &\longrightarrow& C \\ \downarrow && \downarrow && \downarrow \\ D &\longrightarrow& E &\underset{}{\longrightarrow}& F }

    the square on the right is a homotoy pullback (def. ) then the left square is, too, precisely if the total rectangle is;

  2. in the presence of functorial factorization (def. ) through weak equivalences followed by fibrations:

    every retract of a homotopy pullback square (in the category 𝒞 f \mathcal{C}_f^{\Box} of commuting squares in 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f) is itself a homotopy pullback square.

Proof

For the first statement: choose a factorization of CWF^FibFC \overset{\in W}{\to} \hat F \overset{\in Fib}{\to} F, pull it back to a factorization BB^FibEB \to \hat B \overset{\in Fib}{\to} E and assume that BB^B \to \hat B is a weak equivalence, i.e. that the right square is a homotopy pullback. Now use the ordinary pasting law to conclude.

For the second statement: functorially choose a factorization of the two right vertical morphisms of the squares and factor the squares through the pullbacks of the corresponding fibrations along the bottom morphisms, respectively. Now the statement that the squares are homotopy pullbacks is equivalent to their top left vertical morphisms being weak equivalences. Factor these top left morphisms functorially as cofibrations followed by acyclic fibrations. Then the statement that the squares are homotopy pullbacks is equivalent to those top left cofibrations being acyclic. Now the claim follows using that the retract of an acyclic cofibration is an acyclic cofibration (prop. ).

Long sequences

The ordinary fiber, example , of a morphism has the property that taking it twice is always trivial:

*fib(fib(f))fib(f)XfY. \ast \simeq fib(fib(f)) \longrightarrow fib(f) \longrightarrow X \overset{f}{\longrightarrow} Y \,.

This is crucially different for the homotopy fiber, def. . Here we discuss how this comes about and what the consequences are.

Proposition

Let 𝒞 f\mathcal{C}_f be a category of fibrant objects of a model category, def. and let f:XYf \colon X \longrightarrow Y be a morphism in its category of pointed objects, def. . Then the homotopy fiber of its homotopy fiber, def. , is isomorphic, in Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}), to the loop space object ΩY\Omega Y of YY (def. , prop. ):

hofib(hofib(XfY))ΩY. hofib(hofib(X \overset{f}{\to}Y)) \simeq \Omega Y \,.
Proof

Assume without restriction that f:XYf \;\colon\; X \longrightarrow Y is already a fibration between fibrant objects in 𝒞\mathcal{C} (otherwise replace and rename). Then its homotopy fiber is its ordinary fiber, sitting in a pullback square

hofib(f) F i X f * Y. \array{ hofib(f) \simeq & F &\overset{i}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ & \downarrow && \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ & \ast &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.

In order to compute hofib(hofib(f))hofib(hofib(f)), i.e. hofib(i)hofib(i), we need to replace the fiber inclusion ii by a fibration. Using the factorization lemma for this purpose yields, after a choice of path space object Path(X)Path(X) (def. ), a replacement of the form

F W F× XPath(X) i Fib i˜ X. \array{ F &\overset{\in W}{\longrightarrow}& F \times_X Path(X) \\ &{}_{\mathllap{i}}\searrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{\tilde i}}_{\mathrlap{\in Fib}} \\ && X } \,.

Hence hofib(i)hofib(i) is the ordinary fiber of this map:

hofib(hofib(f))F× XPath(X)× X*Ho(𝒞 */). hofib(hofib(f)) \simeq F \times_X Path(X) \times_X \ast \;\;\;\; \in Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) \,.

Notice that

F× XPath(X)*× YPath(X) F \times_X Path(X) \; \simeq \; \ast \times_Y Path(X)

because of the pasting law:

F× XPath(X) Path(X) (pb) F i X (pb) f * Y. \array{ F \times_X Path(X) &\longrightarrow& Path(X) \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow \\ F &\overset{i}{\longrightarrow}& X \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{f}} \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.

Hence

hofib(hofib(f))*× YPath(X)× X*. hofib(hofib(f)) \;\simeq\; \ast \times_Y Path(X) \times_X \ast \,.

Now we claim that there is a choice of path space objects Path(X)Path(X) and Path(Y)Path(Y) such that this model for the homotopy fiber (as an object in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) sits in a pullback diagram of the following form:

*× YPath(X)× X* Path(X) WF ΩY Path(Y)× YX (pb) * Y×X. \array{ \ast \times_Y Path(X) \times_X \ast &\longrightarrow& Path(X) \\ \downarrow && \downarrow\mathrlap{\in W \cap F} \\ \Omega Y &\longrightarrow& Path(Y)\times_Y X \\ \downarrow &(pb)& \downarrow \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Y \times X } \,.

By the pasting law and the pullback stability of acyclic fibrations, this will prove the claim.

To see that the bottom square here is indeed a pullback, check the universal property: A morphism out of any AA into *×Y×XPath(Y)× YX\ast \underset{Y \times X}{\times} Path(Y) \times_Y X is a morphism a:APath(Y)a \colon A \to Path(Y) and a morphism b:AXb \colon A \to X such that p 0(a)=*p_0(a) = \ast, p 1(a)=f(b)p_1(a) = f(b) and b=*b = \ast. Hence it is equivalently just a morphism a:APath(Y)a \colon A \to Path(Y) such that p 0(a)=*p_0(a) = \ast and p 1(a)=*p_1(a) = \ast. This is the defining universal property of ΩY*×YPath(Y)×Y*\Omega Y \coloneqq \ast \underset{Y}{\times} Path(Y) \underset{Y}{\times} \ast.

Now to construct the right vertical morphism in the top square (Quillen 67, page 3.1): Let Path(Y)Path(Y) be any path space object for YY and let Path(X)Path(X) be given by a factorization

(id X,if,id X):XWPath(X)FibX× YPath(Y)× YX (id_X, \; i \circ f, \; id_X) \;\colon\; X \overset{\in W}{\to} Path(X) \overset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow} X \times_Y Path(Y) \times_Y X

and regarded as a path space object of XX by further comoposing with

(pr 1,pr 3):X× YPath(Y)× YXFibX×X. (pr_1,pr_3)\colon X \times_Y Path(Y) \times_Y X \overset{\in Fib}{\longrightarrow} X \times X \,.

We need to show that Path(X)Path(Y)× YXPath(X)\to Path(Y) \times_Y X is an acyclic fibration.

It is a fibration because X× YPath(Y)× YXPath(Y)× YXX\times_Y Path(Y) \times_Y X \to Path(Y)\times_Y X is a fibration, this being the pullback of the fibration XfYX \overset{f}{\to} Y.

To see that it is also a weak equivalence, first observe that Path(Y)× YXWFibX Path(Y)\times_Y X \overset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow} X, this being the pullback of the acyclic fibration of lemma . Hence we have a factorization of the identity as

id X:XWiPath(X)Path(Y)× YXWFibX id_X \;\colon\; X \underoverset{\in W}{i}{\longrightarrow} Path(X) \overset{}{\longrightarrow} Path(Y)\times_Y X \underset{\in W \cap Fib}{\longrightarrow} X

and so finally the claim follows by two-out-of-three (def. ).

Remark

There is a conceptual way to understand prop. as follows: If we draw double arrows to indicate homotopies, then a homotopy fiber (def. ) is depicted by the following filled square:

hofib(f) * X f Y \array{ hofib(f) &\longrightarrow& \ast \\ \downarrow &\swArrow& \downarrow \\ X &\underset{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y }

just like the ordinary fiber (example ) is given by a plain square

fib(f) * X f Y. \array{ fib(f) &\longrightarrow& \ast \\ \downarrow && \downarrow \\ X &\underset{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y } \,.

One may show that just like the fiber is the universal solution to making such a commuting square (a pullback limit cone def. ), so the homotopy fiber is the universal solution up to homotopy to make such a commuting square up to homotopy – a homotopy pullback homotopy limit cone.

Now just like ordinary pullbacks satisfy the pasting law saying that attaching two pullback squares gives a pullback rectangle, the analogue is true for homotopy pullbacks. This implies that if we take the homotopy fiber of a homotopy fiber, thereby producing this double homotopy pullback square

hofib(g) hofib(f) * g * X f Y \array{ hofib(g) &\longrightarrow& hofib(f) &\longrightarrow& \ast \\ \downarrow &\swArrow& \downarrow^{\mathrlap{g}} &\swArrow& \downarrow \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& X &\underset{f}{\longrightarrow}& Y }

then the total outer rectangle here is itself a homotopy pullback. But the outer rectangle exhibits the homotopy fiber of the point inclusion, which, via def. and lemma , is the loop space object:

ΩY * * Y. \array{ \Omega Y &\longrightarrow& \ast \\ \downarrow &\swArrow& \downarrow \\ \ast &\longrightarrow& Y } \,.
Proposition

Let 𝒞\mathcal{C} be a model category and let f:XYf \colon X \to Y be morphism in the pointed homotopy category Ho(𝒞 */)Ho(\mathcal{C}^{\ast/}) (prop. ). Then:

  1. There is a long sequence to the left in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} of the form

    ΩXΩ¯fΩYhofib(f)XfY, \cdots \longrightarrow \Omega X \overset{\overline{\Omega} f}{\longrightarrow} \Omega Y \longrightarrow hofib(f) \longrightarrow X \overset{f}{\longrightarrow} Y \,,

    where each morphism is the homotopy fiber (def. ) of the following one: the homotopy fiber sequence of ff. Here Ω¯f\overline{\Omega}f denotes Ωf\Omega f followed by forming inverses with respect to the group structure on Ω()\Omega(-) from prop. .

    Moreover, for A𝒞 */A\in \mathcal{C}^{\ast/} any object, then there is a long exact sequence

    [A,Ω 2Y] *[A,Ωhofib(f)] *[A,ΩX] *[A,ΩY][A,hofib(f)] *[A,X] *[A,Y] * \cdots \to [A,\Omega^2 Y]_\ast \longrightarrow [A,\Omega hofib(f)]_\ast \longrightarrow [A, \Omega X]_\ast \longrightarrow [A,\Omega Y] \longrightarrow [A,hofib(f)]_\ast \longrightarrow [A,X]_\ast \longrightarrow [A,Y]_\ast

    of pointed sets, where [,] *[-,-]_\ast denotes the pointed set valued hom-functor of example .

  2. Dually, there is a long sequence to the right in 𝒞 */\mathcal{C}^{\ast/} of the form

    XfYhocofib(f)ΣXΣ¯fΣY, X \overset{f}{\longrightarrow} Y \overset{}{\longrightarrow} hocofib(f) \longrightarrow \Sigma X \overset{\overline{\Sigma} f}{\longrightarrow} \Sigma Y \to \cdots \,,

    where each morphism is the homotopy cofiber (def. ) of the previous one: the homotopy cofiber sequence of ff. Moreover, for A𝒞 */A\in \mathcal{C}^{\ast/} any object, then there is a long exact sequence

    [Σ 2X,A] *[Σhocofib(f),A] *[ΣY,A] *[ΣX,A][hocofib(f),A] *[Y,A] *[X,A] * \cdots \to [\Sigma^2 X, A]_\ast \longrightarrow [\Sigma hocofib(f), A]_\ast \longrightarrow [\Sigma Y, A]_\ast \longrightarrow [\Sigma X, A] \longrightarrow [hocofib(f),A]_\ast \longrightarrow [Y,A]_\ast \longrightarrow [X,A]_\ast

    of pointed sets, where [,] *[-,-]_\ast denotes the pointed set valued hom-functor of example .

(Quillen 67, I.3, prop. 4)

Proof

That there are long sequences of this form is the result of combining prop. and prop. .

It only remains to see that it is indeed the morphisms Ω¯f\overline{\Omega} f that appear, as indicated.

In order to see this, it is convenient to adopt the following notation: for f:XYf \colon X \to Y a morphism, then we denote the collection of generalized element of its homotopy fiber as

hofib(f)={(x,f(x)γ 1*)} hofib(f) = \left\{ (x, f(x) \overset{\gamma_1}{\rightsquigarrow} \ast) \right\}

indicating that these elements are pairs consisting of an element xx of XX and a “path” (an element of the given path space object) from f(x)f(x) to the basepoint.

This way the canonical map hofib(f)Xhofib(f) \to X is (x,f(x)*)x(x, f(x) \rightsquigarrow \ast) \mapsto x. Hence in this notation the homotopy fiber of the homotopy fiber reads

hofib(hofib(f))={((x,f(x)γ 1*),xγ 2*)}. hofib(hofib(f)) = \left\{ ( (x, f(x) \overset{\gamma_1}{\rightsquigarrow} \ast), x \overset{\gamma_2}{\rightsquigarrow} \ast ) \right\} \,.

This identifies with ΩY\Omega Y by forming the loops

γ 1f(γ 2¯), \gamma_1 \cdot f(\overline{\gamma_2}) \,,

where the overline denotes reversal and the dot denotes concatenation.

Then consider the next homotopy fiber

hofib(hofib(hofib(f)))={(((x,f(x)γ 1*),xγ 2*),(x γ 3 * f(x) f(γ 3) * γ 1 *))}, hofib(hofib(hofib(f))) = \left\{ \left( ( (x, f(x) \overset{\gamma_1}{\rightsquigarrow} \ast), x \overset{\gamma_2}{\rightsquigarrow} \ast ), \left( \array{ x && \overset{\gamma_3}{\rightsquigarrow} && \ast \\ f(x) &&\overset{f(\gamma_3)}{\rightsquigarrow}&& \ast \\ & {}_{\mathllap{\gamma_1}}\searrow & \Rightarrow & \swarrow_{\mathllap{}} \\ && \ast } \right) \right) \right\} \,,

where on the right we have a path in hofib(f)hofib(f) from (x,f(x)γ 1*)(x, f(x)\overset{\gamma_1}{\rightsquigarrow} \ast) to the basepoint element. This is a path γ 3\gamma_3 together with a path-of-paths which connects f 1f_1 to f(γ 3)f(\gamma_3).

By the above convention this is identified with the loop in XX which is

γ 2(γ¯ 3). \gamma_2 \cdot (\overline{\gamma}_3) \,.

But the map to hofib(hofib(f))hofib(hofib(f)) sends this data to ((x,f(x)γ 1*),xγ 2*)( (x, f(x) \overset{\gamma_1}{\rightsquigarrow} \ast), x \overset{\gamma_2}{\rightsquigarrow} \ast ), hence to the loop

γ 1f(γ 2¯) f(γ 3)f(γ 2¯) =f(γ 3γ 2¯) =f(γ 2γ¯ 3¯) =f(γ 2γ¯ 3)¯, \begin{aligned} \gamma_1 \cdot f( \overline{\gamma_2} ) & \simeq f(\gamma_3) \cdot f(\overline{\gamma_2}) \\ & = f( \gamma_3 \cdot \overline{\gamma_2} ) \\ & = f ( \overline{\gamma_2 \cdot \overline{\gamma}_3} ) \\ & = \overline{f(\gamma_2 \cdot \overline{\gamma}_3) } \end{aligned} \,,

hence to the reveral of the image under ff of the loop in XX.

Remark

In (Quillen 67, I.3, prop. 3, prop. 4) more is shown than stated in prop. : there the connecting homomorphism ΩYhofib(f)\Omega Y \to hofib(f) is not just shown to exist, but is described in detail via an action of ΩY\Omega Y on hofib(f)hofib(f) in Ho(𝒞)Ho(\mathcal{C}). This takes a good bit more work. For our purposes here, however, it is sufficient to know that such a morphism exists at all, hence that ΩYhofib(hofib(f))\Omega Y \simeq hofib(hofib(f)).

Example

Let 𝒞=(Top cg) Quillen\mathcal{C} = (Top_{cg})_{Quillen} be the classical model structure on topological spaces (compactly generated) from theorem , theorem . Then using the standard pointed topological path space objects Maps(I +,X)Maps(I_+,X) from def. and example as the abstract path space objects in def. , via prop. , this gives that

[*,Ω nX]π n(X) [\ast, \Omega^n X] \simeq \pi_n(X)

is the nnth homotopy group, def. , of XX at its basepoint.

Hence using A=*A = \ast in the first item of prop. , the long exact sequence this gives is of the form

π 3(X)f *π 3(Y)π 2(hofib(f))π 2(X)f *π 2(Y)π 1(hofib(f))π 1(X)f *π 1(Y)*. \cdots \to \pi_3(X) \overset{f_\ast}{\longrightarrow} \pi_3(Y) \longrightarrow \pi_2(hofib(f)) \overset{}{\longrightarrow} \pi_2(X) \overset{-f_\ast}{\longrightarrow} \pi_2(Y) \longrightarrow \pi_1(hofib(f)) \overset{}{\longrightarrow} \pi_1(X) \overset{f_\ast}{\longrightarrow} \pi_1(Y) \overset{}{\longrightarrow} \ast \,.

This is called the long exact sequence of homotopy groups induced by ff.

Remark

As we pass to stable homotopy theory (in Part 1)), the long exact sequences in example become long not just to the left, but also to the right. Given then a tower of fibrations, there is an induced sequence of such long exact sequences of homotopy groups, which organizes into an exact couple. For more on this see at Interlude – Spectral sequences (this remark).

Example

Let again 𝒞=(Top cg) Quillen\mathcal{C} = (Top_{cg})_{Quillen} be the classical model structure on topological spaces (compactly generated) from theorem , theorem , as in example . For ETop cg */E \in Top_{cg}^{\ast/} any pointed topological space and i:AXi \colon A \hookrightarrow X an inclusion of pointed topological spaces, the exactness of the sequence in the second item of prop.

[hocofib(i),E][X,E] *[A,E] * \cdots \to [hocofib(i), E] \longrightarrow [X,E]_\ast \longrightarrow [A,E]_\ast \to \cdots

gives that the functor

[,E] *:(Top CW */) opSet */ [-,E]_\ast \;\colon\; (Top^{\ast/}_{CW})^{op} \longrightarrow Set^{\ast/}

behaves like one degree in an additive reduced cohomology theory (def.). The Brown representability theorem (thm.) implies that all additive reduced cohomology theories are degreewise representable this way (prop.).

The suspension/looping adjunction

We conclude this discussion of classical homotopy theory with the key statement that leads over to stable homotopy theory in Introduction to Stable homotopy theory – 1: the suspension and looping adjunction on the classical pointed homotopy category.

Proposition

The canonical loop space functor Ω\Omega and reduced suspension functor Σ\Sigma from prop. on the classical pointed homotopy category from def. are adjoint functors, with Σ\Sigma left adjoint and Ω\Omega right adjoint:

(ΣΩ):Ho(Top */)ΩΣHo(Top */). (\Sigma \dashv \Omega) \;\colon\; Ho(Top^{\ast/}) \stackrel{\overset{\Sigma}{\longleftarrow}}{\underset{\Omega}{\longrightarrow}} Ho(Top^{\ast/}) \,.

Moreover, this is equivalently the adjoint pair of derived functors, according to prop. , of the Quillen adjunction

(Top cg */) QuillenMaps(S 1,) *S 1()(Top cg */) Quillen (Top_{cg}^{\ast/})_{Quillen} \underoverset {\underset{Maps(S^1, -)_\ast}{\longrightarrow}} {\overset{S^1 \wedge (-)}{\longleftarrow}} {\bot} (Top_{cg}^{\ast/})_{Quillen}

of cor. .

Proof

By prop. we may represent Σ\Sigma and Ω\Omega by any choice of cylinder objects and path space objects (def. ).

The standard topological path space () I(-)^I is generally a path space object by prop. . With prop. this shows that

ΩMaps(S 1,) *. \Omega \simeq \mathbb{R} Maps(S^1,-)_\ast \,.

Moreover, by the existence of CW-approximations (remark ) we may represent each object in the homotopy category by a CW-complex. On such, the standard topological cylinder ()×I(-)\times I is a cylinder object by prop. . With prop. this shows that

Σ𝕃(S 1()). \Sigma \simeq \mathbb{L} (S^1 \wedge (-)) \,.
Final remark

What is called stable homotopy theory is the result of universally forcing the (ΣΩ)(\Sigma\dashv \Omega)-adjunction of prop. to become an equivalence of categories.

This is the topic of the next section at Introduction to Stable homotopy theory – 1.

\,

References

A concise and yet self-contained re-write of the proof (Quillen 67) of the classical model structure on topological spaces is provided in

For general model category theory a decent review is in

The equivalent definition of model categories that we use here is due to

  • André Joyal, appendix E of The theory of quasi-categories and its applications (pdf)

The two originals are still a good source to turn to:

For the restriction to the convenient category of compactly generated topological spaces good sources are

  • L. Gaunce Lewis, Compactly generated spaces (pdf), appendix A of The Stable Category and Generalized Thom Spectra PhD thesis Chicago, 1978

  • Neil Strickland, The category of CGWH spaces, 2009 (pdf)

Graphics taken from

  • Fernando Muro, Representability of Cohomology Theories, Joint Mathematical Conference CSASC 2010, 22–27 January 2010, Prague, Czech Republic (slides)

Last revised on September 9, 2024 at 12:45:34. See the history of this page for a list of all contributions to it.